You are on page 1of 97

YD;K 8Il CONTENTS

EEK 81.2AHm
C59

COKOJlOBa M. A. H,!lJl. Introduction 6

C59 TcopcTH"ICCKruI (j)OHCTHKa aHrJIHHcKOro H3bIKa / M. A COKOJIOBa, 11. C. THXo- 1. Phonetics as a Linguistic Discipline 6

HOM, P. M. THxoHoBa, E. JI. (J)pcH,uHHa. D;y6Ha: (J)CHHKC+, 2010. - 192 c. 2. Divisions and Branchcs of Phonetics 7

3. Methods of Phonetic Investigation 10

ISBN 978-5-9279-0153-1 4. Phonetics and Other Disciplines 12

B yqc6HHKC H3JIafaJOTCH OCHOBbI TCOpCTJ:IlIeCKOfO Kypca (j)OHCTHKH aHrJIHHC­


5. Spheres of Practical Application 14

KOfO H3bIKa. B6 fJIaBaX YIIc6HHKa npC)J,CTaBJICHO orIHcaHHe (j)oHenI'ICcKoro


CTpmr COBpCMeHHOfO aHfJIHHcKOro H3bIKa H paCCMOTPeHbT np06JIeMhI HCrrOJIb- Chapter I. The Functional Aspect of Speech Sounds ...................... 16

30BaH.IDI (j)OHCTHIICCKHX C)J,HHI1IJ, B rrpoIJ,CCCC KOMMYHI1KaIJ,HH. Kypc HanpaBJIeH


1.1. The Phoneme ........ ........................ ............................... 17

Ha (j)OpMHpoBaHHc TCOpeTH'fCCKOH 6a3bI, Hco6xo;rJ:HMOH )J,JIH o6yqeHHH aHrJIHH­


CKOMY IlPOH3HOillCHHIO. 1.1.1. The definition of the phoneme ..................................... 17

Y'le6HUIC npeOHG3Ha'leH Oilf/ cmyoeHmoeljJalCYllbmemoe UHocmpaHHblX Jl3b1ICOe ne­ 1.1.2. The phoneme as a unity ofthrec aspects ....................... 18

Oa202U'leCICUX eY30e, a malC:HCe OjlJl UlUPOICOCO ICpY2a 'lumame;zeti, U3Y'laJOUJ,UX aH2­ 1.1.3. Phonological and phonetic mistakes in pronunciation .... 23

J1UUCICUti Jl3b1IC U UHmepeCYIOUJ,uxCJl meopueu Jl3bllCa.


1.2. Transcription ................................................................. 24

Y,llK 811
1.3. Main Trends in the Phoneme Theory ............................. 25

EEK 81.2AHrn

1.4. Methods of Phonological Analysis ................................. 28

1.4.1. The aim of phonological analysis .................................. 28

1.4.2. Distributional method of phonological analysis ............ 29

1.4.3. Semantically distributional method ofphonological

ISBN 978-5-9279-0153-1 © M. A. CoKOJIOBa, I1.. C. Tl1XoHoBa, P. M. TI1XOHOBa,


E. n. <I>peWlI1Ha, cO)J,ep)Kl!Hl1e, 2010

analysis ........................................................................ 30

© <I>CHHKC+, o<popMJIeHl1e, 2010


1.4.4. Methods of establishing the phonemic status of speech

sounds in weakpositions. Morphonology ...................... 32

1. 5. The System of English Phonemes .................................. 34

M. A. COKOJIOBa, H. C. THxoHoBa, P. M. THXOHOBa, E. JI. <l>petf,llHHa 1.5.1. The system of consonants ............................................. 35

1.5.2. The system of vowels .................................................... 39

TEOPETIIqECKAH <l>OHETIIKA AHrJIIIHCKOrO H3blKA


1.5.3. Modifications of sounds in connected speech ............... 45

PC)J,aKTOp O. E. CaaKJI.u
1.5.3.1. Modifications of consonants ........................... 45

KOMl1bTOTCPHblll HaGop H. If. UIefJ'tyIC 1.5.3.2. Modifications of vowels ................................... 47

KOMITbTOTCpHaJ'l BCPCTKaA.H. MUMue6 Summary ...................................................................... 48

,[\113allH OMO)l(KH C. IO. UIeudpulC

<I>opMaT 60 x 90 V'6' THpa2K 2000 ::!K3. 3aKa3 N2 K-2539. Chapter n. Syllabic Structure of English Words 5]
2.1. The Phenomenon of the Syllable 51

«<I>eHI1KC+». 141983, MocK. 06)1., r. ,[\y6Ha, yJI. TBepcKM, )J,.6A, 0<1>.156.


2.2. Syllable Formation 53

http://www.phoenix.dubna.ru E-mail: pat&uk@dubna.ru 2.3. Syllable Division (Phonotactics) 53

2.4. Functional A'lpect ofthe Syllable 55

OmeqaTalIO B fYll.HfIK "qYBamlH!~

428019, r. Qe6oKcapbI, rIp. I1.. 5lKOBJIeBa, 13


Summary 56

4 Contents Contents 5

Chapter III. Word Stress ................................................................... 57


5.2. Stylistic Modifications of Speech Sounds ..................... 114

3.1. Definition. The Nature of Stress. ....................... ............ 57


Stylistic Use of Intonation 116

3.2. English Word Stress. Production and Perception ............ 59


5.3.1. Phonostyles and their registers 116

3.3. Degrees ofWord Stress .................................................. 60


5.3.2. Infonnational style 118

3.4. Placement ofWord Stress .............................................. 61


a) spheres of discourse 118

b) informational texts (reading) 120

3.5. Tendencies in the Placement of Word Stress ................... 64


c) informational monologues (speaking) 123

3.6. Functions ofWord Stress ............................................... 65


infonnational dialogues 128

e) press reporting and broadcasting 133

Summary ...................................................................... 66

5.3.3. Academic style 137

5.3.4. Publicistic style 140

Chapter rv. Intonation..................................................................... 68


5.3.5. Declamatory style. Artistic reading 144

Definition ofIntonation ................................................ 68


5.3.6. Conversational style 148

4.2. Components of Intonation ............................................ 70


Summary 156

4.3. Intonation Pattern as the Basic Unit of I.n.tonation ......... 72

4.4. Notation ....................................................................... 78


Chapter VI. Social and Territorial Vctrieties of English ..................... 158

4.5. Functions ofIntonation ................................................ 79


6.1. Social Phonetics and Dialectology ............................... 158

4.5. L Communicative function as the basic function


6.2. Spread of English ........................................................ 162

of intonati on 79
6.3. English-based Pronunciation Standards of English ...... 163

4.5.2. Distinctive function 81


6.3.1. British English ........................................................... 163

4.5.3. Organising function 85


6.3.2. Received pronunciation ............................................. 164

4.5.4. Intonation in discourse 88


6.3.3. Changes in the standard ............................................. 166

4.5.5. Pragmatic function 93


6.3.4. Regional non-RP accents of England ......................... 172

4.5.6. Rhetorical function 95


6.3.5. \\elsh English ............................................................. 177

4.6. Rhythm ........... 96


6.3.6. Scottish English ......................................................... 178

4.6.1. Speech rhythm. Definition. Typology ........................... 96


6.3.7. Northern Ireland English ........................................... 180

4.6.2. Rhythmic group as the basic unit ofrhYlhm .................. 98


6.4. American-based Pronunciation Standards of English ... 182

4.6.3. Rhythm in different types of discourse .......................... 98


6.4.1. General American 183

4.6.4. Functions of rhythm .................................................. 101


188

Summary
Summary .................................................................... l02

References 190

Chapter V. Phonostylistics ........... ......... ......................... ....... ........ 105

5.1. The Problems ofPhonostylistics .................................. 105

5.1.1. Phonostylistics as a bmnch of phonetics ..................... 105

5. 1.2. Extmlinguistic situation and its components ..... .......... 107

5.1.3. Style-fonning factors ................................................. 109

5.1.4. Classification of phonetic styles .................. ................ 112

INTRODUCTION 2. Divisions and Branches of Phonetics 7

no language description is complete without phonetics, the science con­


cerned with the spoken medium oflanguage. That is why phonetics claims
1. Phonetics as a Linguistic Discipline to be of equal importance with grammar and lexicology.
2. Divisions and Branches of Phonetics
3. Methods of Phonetic Investigation
4. Phonetics and Other Disciplines 2. Divisions and Branches of Phonetics
5. Spheres of Practical Application
Traditionally phonetics is divided into general phonetics which studies
the complex nature of phonetic phenomena and formulates phonetic laws
and principles and special phonetics which is concerned with the phonetic
1. Phonetics as a Linguistic Discipline structure ofa particular language. Admittedly, phonetic theories worked out
by general phonetics are based on the data provided by special phonetics
This book is aimed at future teachers of English. The teachers of a for­ while special phonetics relies on the ideas of general phonetics to interpret
eign language are definitely aware of the existence of phonetics. They are phonetic phenomena of a particular language.
always being told that it is essential that they should be skilful phoneticians. Special phonetics can be subdivided into descriptive and historical. Spe­
The reaction may be different. Some teachers meet it with understanding. cial descriptive phonetics studies the phonetic structure ofthe language syn­
Some protest that it is not in their power for various reasons to become pho­ chronically, while historical phonetics looks at it in its historical develop­
neticians, others deny that it is really necessary. ment, diachronically. Historical phonetics is part of the history of the
"Is it in fact necessary for a language teacher to be a phonetician? I language. The study ofthe historical development ofthe phonetic system of
would reply that all language teachers willy-nilly are phoneticians. It is not a language helps to lmderstand its present and predict its future.
possible, for practical purposes, to teach a foreign language to any type of Another important division of phonetics is into segmental phonetics,
learner, for any purpose, by any method, without giving some attention to which is concerned with individual sounds (1. e. "segments" of speech) and
pronunciation. And any attention to pronunciation is phonetics." (Aber­ suprasegmental phonetics whose domain is the larger units of connected
crombie, 1956: 28) speech: syllables, words, phrases and text.
What does phonetics study? Phonetics is concerned with the human Figure 1
noises, by which the thought is actualized or given audible shape: the nature
of these noises, their combinations, and their functions in relation to phonetics
meaning. Phonetics studies the sound system ofthe language, i. e. segmen­
tal phonemes, word stress, syllabic structure and intonation. It is primarily
concerned with expression level. However, phonetics takes the content
el into consideration too. Only meaningful sound sequences are regarded as segmental suprasegmental
speech, and the science ofphonetics , in principle at least, is concerned only phonetics phonetics
with such sounds produced by a human vocal apparatus as are, or may be,
carriers of organized information of language. In other words, phonetics is
concerned both with the expression level ofphonetic units and their ability Phonetics has two aspects: on the one hand, phonology, the study of the
to carry meaning. No kind oflinguistic study can be made without constant functional aspect of phonetic units, and on the other, the study of the sub­
consideration of the material and functional levels. stance of phonetic units.
It follows from this that phonetics is a basic branch of linguistics; nei­ Before analysing the linguistic function of phonetic units we need to
ther linguistic theory nor linguistic practice can do without phonetics, and know how the vocal mechanism acts in producing oral speech and what
8 Introduction 2. Divisions and Branches of Phonetics 9

methods are applied in investigating the material form of the language, in The height of the speaking voice depends on the frequency ofthe vibra­
other words its substance. tions. The more frequently the vocal cords vibrate the higher the pitch is.
Human speech is the result ofa highly complicated series of events. The The typical speaking voice of a woman is higher than that ofa man because
formation of the message takes place at a linguistic level, i. e. in the brain of the vocal cords of a woman vibrate more frequently. We are able to vary the
the speaker; this stage may be called psychological. The message formed in the rate of the vibration thus producing modifications of the pitch component
brain is transmitted along the nervous system to the speech organs. Therefore of intonation. More than that. We are able to modify the size of the puff of
we may say that the human brain controls the behaviour of the articulating air which escapes at each vibration of the vocal cords, i. e. we can alter the
organs which results in producing a particular pattern ofspeech sounds. This amplitude of the vibration which causes changes of the loudness of the
second stage may be called physiological. The movements of the speech ap­ sound heard by the listener.
paratus disturb the air stream thus producing sound waves. Consequently the From the larynx the air-stream passes to supraglottal cavities, i. e. to the
third stage may be called physical or acoustic. Further, any communication pharynx, the mouth and the nasal cavities. The shapes of these cavities
requires a listener, as well as a speaker. So the last stages are the reception of modify the note produced in the larynx thus giving rise to particular speech
the sound waves by the listener's hearing physiological apparatus, the trans­ sounds.
missiou of the spoken message through the nervous system to the brain and There are three branches of phonetics each corresponding to a different
the linguistic interpretation ofthe information conveyed. stage in the communication process described above. Each ofthese branch­
Although not a single one ofthe organs involved in the speech mecha­ es uses a special set of methods.
nism is used only for speaking we can for practical purposes use the term The branch of phonetics that studies the way in which the air is set in
"organs of speech", meaning the organs which are active, directly or indi­ motion, the movements of the speech organs and the coordination of these
rectly, in the process ofspeech sound production. movements in the production of single sounds and trains ofsounds is called
In accordance with their linguistic function the organs ofspeech may be articulatory phonetics. Articulatory phonetics is concerned with the way
grouped as follows: speech sounds are produced by the organs of speech, in other words the
The respiratory or power mechanism furnishes the flow of air which is mechanisms of speech production.
the first requisite for the production of speech sounds. This mechanism is Acoustic phonetics studies the way in which the air vibrates between the
formed by the lungs, the wind-pipe and the bronchi. The air-stream ex­ speaker's mouth and the listener's ear, in other words, the sound wave.
pelled from the lungs provides the most usual source of energy which is Acoustic phonetics is concerned with the physical properties of speech
regulated by the power mechanism. Regulating the force ofthe air-wave the sounds and uses special technologies to measure speech signals.
lungs produce variations in the intensity of speech sounds. Syllabic pulses The branch of phonetics investigating the perception process is known
and dynamic stress, both typical of English, are directly related to the be­ as auditory phonetics. Its interests lie more in the sensation ofhearing which
haviour of the muscles which activate this mechanism. is brain activity, than in the physiological working of the ear or the nervous
From the lungs through the wind-pipe the air-stream passes to the up­ activity between the ear and the brain. The means by which we discriminate
per stages ofthe vocal tract. First ofall it passes to the larynx containing the sounds - quality, sensation of pitch, loudness, length, are relevant here.
vocal cords. The opening between the vocal cords is known as the glottis. branch of phonetics is of special interest to anyone who teaches or
The function of the vocal cords consists in their role as a vibrator set in mo­ studies pronunciation.
tion by the air-stream sent by the lungs. The most important speech func­ As it was mentioned above, phoneticians cannot act only as describ­
tion of the vocal cords is their role in the production of voice. The effect of ers and classifiers of the material form of phonetic units. They are also
voice is achieved when the vocal cords are brought together and vibrate interested in the way in which sound phenomena function in a particular
when subjected to the pressure of air passing from the lungs. The vibration language and what part they play in manifesting the meaningful distinc­
is caused by compressed air forcing an opening ofthe glottis and the follow­ tionsofthe language. The branch of phonetics that studies the linguistic
ing reduced air-pressure permitting the vocal cords to come together. function of consonant and vowel sounds, syllabic structure, word accent
10 Introduction 3. Metods of Phonetic Investigation 11

and prosodic features, such as pitch, loudness and tempo is called pho­ experience in such observation allows him to associate the qualities of the
nology. sound heard with the nature ofthe articulations producing it. Such skills are
In linguistics, function is usually understood as discriminatory func­ obligatory for phoneticians and make phonetics not only a science but also
tion, that the role of the various elements ofthe language in the distin­ an art, an art which must be specially learned. Phonetic research based on
guishing ofone sequence of sounds, such as a word or a sequence ofwords, the methods of direct observation is effective only when the scholars con­
from another of different meaning. Though we consider the discriminatory ducting it are trained in analyzing both the movements of the organs of
function to be the main linguistic function of any phonetic unit we cannot speech and the auditory impression of speech segments.
ignore the other function of phonetic units, that is, their role in the forma­ Instrumental methods were introduced into phonetics in the second half
tion ofsyllables, words, phrases and texts. This functional or social aspect of ofthe 19th century in order to supplement the impressions deriving from the
phonetic phenomena was first introduced by I. A. Baudouin-de-Courtenay. human senses, especially the auditory impressions, since these are affected
Later on N. S. Trubetskoy declared phonology to be a linguistic discipline by the limitations of the perceptual mechanism, and in general are rather
and acoustic phonetics to anatomy, physiology and subjective.
acoustics only. This conception is shared by many foreign linguists who in­ Instrumental analysis is based on the use of special technical devices,
vestigate the material form and the function of oral speech units separately. such as spectrograph, intonograph, x-ray photography and cinematogra­
Russian linguists proceed from the view that language is the medium of phy, laryngoscope and others. In a general way, the introduction of ma­
thought and can exist only in the material form of phonetic units. That is chines for measurements and for instrumental analysis into phonetics has
why they consider phonology a branch of phonetics that investigates its resulted in their use for detailed study ofmany ofthe phenomena which are
most important social aspect. present in the sound wave or in the articulatory process at any given mo­
2 ment, and the changes ofthese phenomena from moment to moment. This
Branches of Phonetics type of investigation together with sensory analysis is widely used in experi­
mental phonetics.
The results available from instrumental analysis supplement those avail­
able from sensory analysis. Practically today there are no areas of phonetics
in which useful work can and is being done without combining these two
articulatory auditory acoustic functional phonetics ways of phonetic investigation. The "subjective" methods of analysis by
phonetics phonetics phonetics (phonology)
sensory impression and the "objective" methods of analysis by instruments
are complementary. Both "objective" and "subjective" methods are widely
used in modern phonetics. Articulatory phonetics borders with anatomy
3. Methods of Phonetic Investigation and physiology, it uses methods of direct observation, whenever it is possible
(lip movement, some tongue movement) combined with x-ray photography
Each branch of phonetics uses its own methods of research. We shall or x-ray cinematography, observation through mirrors as in the laryngo­
consider now some ofthe methods applied in investigating the sound matter scopic investigation of vocal cord movement, etc.
ofthe language. Acoustic phonetics comes close to physics and the tools used in this
They generally distinguish methods of direct observation (phonetic field enable the investigator to measure and analyse the movement ofthe air
studies are carried out without any other instruments of analysis than the in the terms of acoustics. This generally means introducing a microphone
human senses) and instrumental methods based on the use ofvarious into the speech chain, converting the air movement into corresponding
nical devices. electrical activity and analysing the result in terms of frequency ofvibration
From the beginning of phonetics the phonetician has relied to a great and amplitude of vibration in relation to time. The use of various sound
extent on the perception ofhis own speech and the informants' speech. The analysing and sound synthesising machines is generally combined with the
12 Introduction 4. Phonetics and Other Disciplines 13

method of direct observation. Today computer technologies make it possi­ tance for language teachers and language learners in the context of cross­
ble to conduct acoustic spectral analysis ofspeech sounds and intonograph­ cultural communication.
ic analysis. One more example ofinterdisciplinary overlap is the relation oflinguis­
It should be mentioned that computer technologies are widely used tics to psychology. Psycholinguistics as a distinct area ofinterest developed
both for processing and measuring acoustic data and for pronunciation the sixties, and in its early form covered the psychological implications of
training. One of the advantages of using computers for the experimental an extremely broad area, from acoustic phonetics to language pathology.
study is the possibility of storing substantial corpora of various spoken dis­ Nowadays no one would want to deny the existence ofstrong mutual bonds
course to serve as the material for phonetic investigation. between linguistics, phonetics in our case and psychology. Here are some of
Phonology possesses its own methods ofinvestigation which will be de­ the problems covered by psycholinguistics: the acquisition of language by
scribed later in the course. children, the extent to which language meditates or structures thinking;
extent to which language is influenced and itself influences such things as
memory, attention, perception; the problems of speech production and
4. Phonetics and Other Disciplines speech perception; speech pathology.
Phonetics is also closely connected with a number ofnon-linguistic dis­
Our further point will be made in connection with the relationship of ciplines which study different aspects ofspeech production and speech per­
phonetics and other disciplines. As it was already mentioned phonetics is ception: physiology, anatomy, physics (acoustics). In phonetic research
one of the basic branches of linguistics, naturally it is closely connected they use mathematics, statistics, computer science.
with the other linguistic disciplines: lexicology and grammar. There is one more area phonetics is closely connected with. It is the
Special attention should be given to the relations of phonetics and social study of non-verbal means ofcommunication.
sciences. Language is not an isolated phenomenon; it is a part of society, a How do people communicate?
part of ourselves. The functioning of phonetic units in society is studied by Too often there is a difference between what we say and what we think
sociophonetics. It should be mentioned here that over the last few decades we have said, though we use appropriate grammatical structures, words and
there appeared a number ofdistinct interdisciplinary subjects, such as socio­ intonation. It may even cause a break in communication.
linguistics (and sociophonetics correspondingly), psycholinguistics, mathe­ It may happen because we speak with our oral organs, but we converse
maticallinguistics and others. These, as their titles suggest, refer to aspects of with our entire bodies. Conversation consists of much more than a simpJe
language which can be studied from two points ofview (sociology and linguis­ interchange ofspoken words. All ofus communicate with one another non­
tics, psychology and linguistics and so on), which requires awareness and de­ verbally. It means that we communicate without using words and involving
velopment of concepts and the techniques derived from both disciplines. movements of different parts of the body.
Sociophonetics studies the ways in which pronunciation interacts with It is believed that 7% of communication is conveyed by words, 38%
society. In other words, it is the study of the way in which phonetic struc­ by sounds and intonation and 55% - by non-verbal means. They are: facial
tures change in response to different social functions. Society here is used in expression, gestures and postures.
its broadest sense, to cover a spectrum of phenomena such as nationality, D. Crystal insists that the meaning of particular nuclear tones depends
regional and social groups, and specific interactions of individuals within on the combination with particular facial expression.
them. There are innumerable facts to be discovered and considered, even Non-verbal elements express very efficiently the emotional or the mod­
about a language as well investigated as English, concerning, for instance, al side of the message.
the nature ofthe different situations - when we are talking to equals, supe­ The study of non-verbal means of communication is called kinesics.
riors or subordinates; when we are 'on the job', when we are old or young; The analysis ofspoken discourse often includes references both to the pho­
male or female; when we are trying to persuade, inform, agree or disagree netic and non-verbal aspects ofspeech communication. So we can say that
and so on. Needless to say sociophonetic information is of crucial impor­ phonetics overlaps with kinesics.
14 Introduction 5. Spheres of Practical Application 15

The field of phonetics is thus becoming wider and tends to extend over For those who work in speech therapy, which handles pathological con­
the limits originally set by its purely linguistic applications. On the other ditions ofspeech, phonetics forms an essential part ofthe professional train­
hand, the growing interest in phonetics is partly due to increasing recogni­ ing syllabus. Phonetics also enters into the training of teachers of the deaf
tion of the central position of language in every line of social activity. It is and dumb people and can be of relevance to a number of medical and den­
important, however, that the phonetician should remain a linguist and look tal problems.
upon phonetics as a study of the spoken form oflanguage. It is its applica­ Phonetics has proved extremely useful in such spheres as investigations
tion to linguistic phenomena that makes phonetics a social science in the in the historical aspects of languages, in the field of dialectology; designing
proper sense of the word. or improving systems of writing or spelling (orthographies for unwritten
languages, shorthand, spelling reform), in questions involving the spelling
or pronunciation of personal or place names or of words borrowed from
5. Spheres of Practical Application other languages.
At the faculties of foreign language in this country two courses of pho­
Now we shall give an overview ofthe spheres in which phonetics can be netics are introduced: practical and theoretical phonetics.
applied. Practical or normative phonetics studies the substance, the material
A study of phonetics has educational value for everyone, who realizes form of phonetic phenomena in relation to meaning.
the importance of language in human communication. Through the study Theoretical phonetics is mainly concerned with the functioning ofpho­
of the nature oflanguage, especially of spoken language, valuable insights netic units in the language. Theoretical phonetics, as we introduce it here,
are gained into human psychology and into the functioning of a man in so­ regards phonetic phenomena synchronically without any special reference
ciety. That is why we dare say that phonetics has considerable social value. to the historical development of English.
The knowledge of the structure of sound systems, and of the articula­ This course is intended to discuss the problems of phonetic science
tory and acoustic properties of the production of speech is indispensable which are relevant to English language teaching. The teacher must be sure
in the teaching of foreign languages. The teacher has to know the starting that what he/she teaches is linguistically correct. In this course we are to
point, which is the sound system of the pupil's mother tongue, as well as bring together linguistic theory and EFL practice. We hope that this book
the aim of his teaching, which is mastering the pronunciation of the lan­ will enable the teacher to work out a truly scientific approach to pronuncia­
guage to be learnt. He/she must be able to point out the differences be­ tion teaching.
tween these two, and to provide adequate training exercises. Ear training In phonetics as in any other discipline, there are various schools whose
and articulation training are both equally important in modern language views sometimes coincide and sometimes conflict. Occasional reference is
teaching. The introduction of new technologies, computers in particular, made to them but there is no attempt to describe and compare all possible
has brought about a revolution in the teaching of the foreign language traditional and current approaches to the phonetic theory.
pronunciation. As you see from the above, the purpose of this book is to consider the
In our technological age phonetics has become important in a number role of phonetic means in communication and to serve as a general intro­
oftechnological fields connected with communication. The results of pho­ duction to the subject of theoretical phonetics of English which will en­
netic investigations are used in communication engineering. Phonetic data courage the student and the teacher of English to consult more specialized
is obviously needed for creating sound analyzing and sound synthesizing works on particular aspects.
devices, for example machines converting the printed symbols or letters The authors ofthe book hope that the readers have sufficient knowledge
into synthetic speech or automatic typewriters which convert speech di­ of the practical course of English phonetics as well as of the course of gen­
rectly into printed words on paper. erallinguistics, which will serve as the basis for this course.
Phonetics contributes important information to the research in crimi­ The description of the phonetic structure of English will be based on
nology aimed at identifying individuals by voices. Received Pronunciation (RP).
1.1. The Phoneme 17
Chapter I

1.1. The Phoneme


THE FUNCTIONAL ASPECT

OF SPEECH SOUNDS
1.1.1. The defmition ofthe phoneme

To know how sounds are produced by speech organs it is not enough to


This chapter is concerned with the linguistic function of speech sounds, describe and classify them as language units. When we talk about the sounds
of a language, the term "sound" can be interpreted in two rather different
i. e. "segments of speech".
We are going to discuss here the defInitions of the phoneme, methods ways. In the fIrst place, we can say that [t] and [d] are two different sounds
used in establishing the phonemic structure of a language, the system of in English, [t] being fortis and [d] being lenis 1 and we can illustrate this by
English phonemes, modifIcations of sounds in connected speech. showing how they contrast with each other to make a difference of meaning
in a large number of pairs, such as tie die, seat seed, etc. But on the
other hand ifwe listen carefully to the [t] in let us and compare it with the
in let them we can hear that the two sounds are also not the same, the [t] of
1.1. The Phoneme
let us is alveolar, while the [t] of let them is dental. In both examples the
1.1.1. The definition of the phoneme sounds differ in one articulatory feature only; in the second case the differ­
1.1.2. The phoneme as a unity of three as­ ence between the sounds has functionally no significance. It is perfectly
pects clear that the sense of "sound" in these two cases is different. To avoid this
1.1.3. Phonological and phonetic mistakes in ambiguity, the linguist uses two separate terms: "phoneme" is used to mean
pronunciation "sound" in its contrastive sense, and "allophone" is used for sounds which
1.2. Transcription are variants of a phoneme: they usually occur in different positions in
word (i. e. in different environments) and hence cannot contrast with each
1.3. Main Trends in the Phoneme Theory other, nor be used to make meaningful distinctions.
1.4. Methods of Phonological Analysis
<! ... B )!{flBOH pel [11 rrpOH3HOCl1TCSl 3Ha'Il1TCJlbHO oOJIbruee, 'ICM Mhl OfihlKHOBeHHO ,llYMa­
1.4.1. The aim of phonological analysis
eM, KOJU1'fCCTBO pa3Hoofipa3HbIX 3BYKOB, KOTOpb[e B Ka)!{;nOM ,llaHHOM ll3bIKe om,e,llH­
1.4.2. Distributional method of phonological
HHIOTCSl B cpaBHflTeJlbHO HefioJIbruoc 'IHCJlO :mYKOBhlX THIIOB, crrocofiHbIX ,llHcpcpepeH­
analysis l\HpOBaTb CJlOBa H fiX CPOPMbl, T. e. CJIY)KHTb l\eJlJIM 'ICJIOBC'ICCKOro ofimeHHll. 3TH
1.4.3. SemanticaUy distributional method of 3BYKOBblC THrrbl H HMCIOTCJI B BH;ny, KOr,lla roBOPliT 06 OT;nCJIbHhlX 3BYKaX pe'IlL Mbl
phonological analysis 6Yil.eM Ha3bIBaTb fiX cpoHcMaMH. PCaJIbHO rrpOH3HOCHMble pa3JlH'Ufble 3BYKfI, SlBJISlIO­

1.4.5. Methods of establishing the phonemic IUHeCJI reM 'IaCTHbIM, B KOTOPOM peaJIH3YCTCJI 06mec (cpOHCMa), 6y)\eM Ha3blBaTb OT­

status of speech sounds in weak posi­ TCHKaMH cpOHCM. (Ill,ep6a, 1963:


And furthcr on:
tions. Morphonology «qeM )!{C orrpC)leJIJIeTC:;I 3TO o6ruce? O'IcBH;nHo, MMCHHO OfimCHIl.CM, KOTopoe
:;IBJIlieTCll OCHOBHOti: l\eJlblO JI3hlKa, T. e. B KOHe'fHOM C'IeTe CMbICJIOM: e,llHHblH CMbICJI
1.5. The System of English Phonemes 3aCTaRJlHCT Hac ,llll)!{e B GOJlee HJIM MCHCC pa3HbiX 3BYKllX Y3HaBaTb O,llHO H TO )!{e. Ho H
1.5.1. The system of consonants ,lI.aJIbmC, TOJlbKO TaKoe o6LUec B3iKJ:IO mlJI Hac B JIMHrBI1CTHKC, KOTopoe ,llHcpcpcpeHQll­
PYCT ,llaHHYIO rpyrrrry (CKa)!{CM pa3Hbie 'a') OT )lpyroti: rpynI1hl, HMClOmCH ,lI.pyrOH
1.5.2. The system ofvowels
CMbICJl (HarrpllMCp, OT COJ03a 'H', rrpOH3HeceHHoro rpOMKO, rucrrOTOM H T.,ll. ). BOT 3TO
1.5.3. Modifications of sounds in connected o61IIee 11 Ha3bIBaeTCli cpoHeMofi. TaKHM 06pa30M, Ka)KtJ:aH cpOHeMa onpe,lleJIJIeTCSl rrpe­
speech )I()le BCCro 'I'eM, 'ITO OTJIfitlaeT ee OT ,llPYrllX cpOHeM TOfO )!{e Sl3blKa. DnarO,llapJI 3TOMY
Bce cpOHeMbI Ka)!{tJ:oro ,llaHHOro H3bIKa 06pa3YJOT C,llIlHYJO CllCTCMY I1POTHBOIIOJlO)!{­
1.5.3.1. Modifications of consonants
HOCTeti:, r,llC KaiKJ:~b[H 'fJICH onpe,lleJIJICTCJI cepHCH pa3JlH'IHb[X rrpOTMBOIIOnO)!{CHHH KaK
1.5.3.2. Modifications ofvowels
OTil.CJIbHhlX CPOHCM, TaK H HX rpynrr».
Chapter 1. The Functional Aspect of Speech Sounds 1.1. The Phoneme 19
18

The most comprehensive defmition ofthe phoneme was first introduced [d] when not affected by the articulation of the preceding or following
by the Russian linguist L. V. Shcherba. sounds is a plosive, forelingual apical, alveolar, lenis stop. This is how it
The concise form ofthis definition could be: sounds in isolation or in such words as door, darn, down, etc., when it re­
The phoneme is a minimal abstract linguistic uuit realized in speech in the tains its typical articulatory characteristics. In this case the consonant [d] is
form of speech souuds opposable to other phonemes of the same language to called the principal allophone. The allophones which do not undergo any
distinguish the meauing of morphemes and words. distinguishable changes in the chain of speech are called principal. At the
According to this definition the phoneme is a unity of three aspects: same time there are quite predictable changes in the articulation of allo­
material, abstract and functional. phones that occur under the influence ofthe neighbouring sounds in differ­
Figure 3 ent phonetic situations. Such allophones are called subsidiary.
Three Aspects of the Phoneme The examples below illustrate the articulatory modifications ofthe pho­
neme [d] in various phonetic contexts:
[d] is slightly palatalized before front vowels and the sonorant [j], e. g.
deal, day, did, did you.
is pronounced without any plosion before another stop, e. g. bedtime,
bad pain, good dog; it is pronounced with the nasal piosion before the nasal
\.
Material aspect
)
( Abstract (
\.
Functional aspect
sonorants [n] and [m], e. g. sudden, admit, could not, could meet; the plosion
is lateral before the lateral sonorant [1], e. g. middle, badly, bad light.
The alveolar position is particularly sensitive to the influence of the
1.1.2. The phoneme as a uuity of three aspects
place ofarticulation ofa following consonant. Thus followed by [r] the con­
Let us consider the phoneme from the point of view of its three aspects. sonant [d] becomes post-alveolar, e. g. dry, dream; followed by the inter­
Firstly, the phoneme is a functional unit. A" you know, in phonetics function is dental [9], [a] it becomes dental, e. g. breadth, lead the way, good thing.
usually understood as discriminatory function, i. e. the role ofvarious compo­ When [d] is followed by the labial [w] it becomes labialized, e. g. dweller.
nents of the phonetic system of the language in distinguishing one morpheme In the initial position [d] is partially devoiced, e. g. dog, dean; in the in­
from another, one word from another or also one utterance from another. tervocalic position or when followed by a sonorant it is fully voiced, e. g.
The opposition of phonemes in the same phonetic environment differ­ order, leader, driver; in the word-final position it is vQiceless, e. g. road,
entiates the meaning ofmorphemes and words: said - says, sleeper - sleepy, raised, old.
bath - path, light -like. These modifications of the phoneme [d] are quite sufficient to demon­
Sometimes the opposition of the phonemes serves to distinguish the strate the articulatory difference between its allophones, though the list of
meaning ofthe whole phrases: he was heard badly - he was hurt badly. Thus them could be easily extended. If you consider the production of the allo­
we may say that the phoneme can fulfil the distinctive function. phones of this phoneme, you will fmd that they possess three articulatory
Secondly, the phoneme is material, real and objective. That means that features in common: all of them are forelingual1enis stops.
it is realized in speech of all English-speaking people in the form of speech Consequently, though allophones of the same phoneme possess similar
sounds, its allophones. The sets of speech sounds, i. e. the allophones be­ articulatory features they may frequently show considerable phonetic dif­
longing to the same phoneme: I) are not identical in their articulatory con­ ferences.
tent though there remains some phonetic similarity between them; 2) are It is perfectly obvious that in teaching English pronunciation the differ­
never used in the same phonetic context. ence between the allophones of the same phoneme should be necessarily
As a first example, let us consider the English phoneme [d], at least considered. The starting point is of course the articulation of the principal
those of its allophones which are known to everybody who studies English allophone, e. g. jd-d-dj: door, double, daughter, dark, etc. Special training
pronunciation. As you know from the practical course ofEnglish phonetics, of the subsidiary allophones should be provided too. Not all the subsidiary
1.1. The Phoneme 21
20 Chapter I. The Functional Aspect of Speech Sounds

allophones are generally paid equal attention to. In teaching the pronuncia­ Thirdly, allophones of the same phoneme, no matter how different
tion of [d], for instance, it is hardly necessary to concentrate on an allo­ their articulation may be, function as the same linguistic unit. The ques­
phone such as [d] before a front vowel as in Russian similar consonants in tion arises why phonetically naive native speakers seldom observe differ­
this position are also palatalized. Neither is it necessary to practise specially ences in the actual articulatory qualities between the allophones of the
same phonemes.
the labialized [d] after the labial [w] because in this position [d] cannot be
pronounced in any other way. Carefully made up exercises will exclude the The native speaker is quite readily aware of the phonemes of his lan­
guage but much less aware of the allophones: it is possible, in fact, that he
danger of a foreign accent.
Allophones are arranged into functionally similar groups, i. e. groups of will not hear the difference between two allophones like the alveolar and
sounds in which the members of each group are not opposed to one an­ dental consonants [d] in the words bread and breadth even when a distinc­
other, but are opposable to members of any other group to distinguish tion is pointed out; a certain amount of ear-training may be needed. The
meanings in otherwise similar sequences. Consequently allophones of the reason is that the phonemes have an important function in the language:
same phoneme never occur in similar phonetic context, they are entirely they differentiate words like tie and die from each other, and to be able to
predictable according to the phonetic environment and cannot differenti­ hear and produce phonemic differences is part of what it means to be a
competent speaker of the language. Allophones, on the other hand, have
ate meanings.
But the speech sounds (phones) which are realized in speech do not no such function: they usually occur in different positions in the word,
i. e. in different environments, and hence cannot be opposed to each oth­
correspond exactly to the allophone predicted by this or that phonetic envi­
ronment. They are modified by phonostylistic, dialectal and individual fac­ er to make meaningful distinctions.
For example the dark [1] occurs following a vowel as inpi/l, cold, but
tors. In fact, no speech sounds are absolutely alike.
Phonemes are important for distinguishing meanings, for knowing it is not found before a vowel, whereas the clear [1] only occurs before a
whether, for instance, the message was take it or tape it. But there is more to vowel, as in lip, like. These two consonants cannot therefore contrast with
speaker-listener exchange than just the "message" itself. The listener may each other in the way that [1] contrasts with [r] in lip - rip or lake - rake.
get a variety of information about the speaker: about the locality he lives in, So the answer appears to be in the functioning of such sounds in a par­
regional origin, his social status, age and even emotional state (angry, tired, ticular language. Sounds which have similar functions in the language
tend to be considered the "same" by the community using that language
excited), and a lot of other facts. Most ofthis social information comes not
from phonemic distinctions, but from phonetic ones. Thus, while phone­ while those which have different functions tend to be classed as "differ­
mic evidence is important for lexical and grammatical meaning, most other ent". In linguistics, as it has been mentioned above, function is generally
aspects of communication are conveyed by more subtle differences of understood as the role of the various elements of the language in distin­
speech sounds, requiring more detailed description at the phonetic level. guishing the meaning. The function of phonemes is to distinguish the
There is more to a speech act than just the meaning ofthe words. meaning ofmorphemes and words. The native speaker does not notice the
The relationships between the phoneme and the phone (speech sound) difference between the allophones of the same phoneme because this dif­
ference does not distinguish meanings.
may be illustrated by the following scheme:
Figure 4 In other words, native speakers abstract themselves from the differ­
ence between the allophones of the same phoneme because it has no
phonostylistic variation functional value. The actual difference between the allophones of the
same phoneme [d], for instance, does not affect the meaning. That's
why members of the English speech community do not realize that in
l dialectal variation )--1 speech sound (phone) I the word dog [d] is alveolar, in dry it is post-alveolar, in breadth it is den­
tal. Another example. In the Russian word nocaaum the stressed vowel
[a] is more front than it is in the word nocaaKa. It is even more front in
individual variation
22 Chapter 1. The Functional Aspect of Speech Sounds 1.1. The Phoneme 23

the word CROem. But Russian-speaking people do not observe this differ­ neme we have to oppose it to some other phoneme in the same phonetic
ence because the three vowel sounds belong to the same phoneme and context. If the opposed sounds differ in one articulatory feature and this
thus the changes in their quality do not distinguish the meaning. So we difference brings about changes in the meaning of the words the contrast­
have good grounds to state that the phoneme is an abstract linguistic ing features are called relevant. For example, the words port and court dif­
unit, it is an abstraction from actual speech sounds, i. e. allophonic fer in one consonant only: the word port has the initial consonant [p], and
modifications. the word court begins with [k]. Both sounds are occlusive and fortis, the
As it has been said before, native speakers do not observe the differ­ only difference being that [p] is labial and [k] is backlingual. Therefore it
ence between the allophones of the same phoneme. At the same time they is possible to say that labial and backlingual articulations are relevant in
realize, quite subconsciously of course, that allophones of each phoneme the system of English consonants.
possess a bundle ofdistinctive features, that make this phoneme function­ The articulatory features which do not serve to distinguish meaning
ally different from all other phonemes of the language concerned. This are called non-distinctive, irrelevant or redundant; for instance, it is im­
functionally relevant bundle of articulatory features is called the invariant possible in English to oppose an aspirated [p] to a non-aspirated one in
of the phoneme. Neither of the articulatory features that form the invari­ the same phonetic context to distinguish meanings. That is why aspiration
ant ofthe phoneme can be changed without affecting the meaning. All the is a non -distinctive feature of English consonants.
allophones of the phoneme [d], for instance, are occlusive, fore lingual,
If occlusive articulation is changed for constrictive one [d] will be 1.1.3. Phonological and phonetic mistakes in pronunciation
replaced by [z], cf. breed - breeze, deal- zeal; [d] will be replaced by [g]
if the forelingual articulation is replaced by the backlingual one, cf. dear­ As it has been mentioned above any change in the invariant ofthe pho­
gear, day - gay. The lenis articulation of [d] cannot be substituted by the neme affects the meaning. Naturally, anyone who studies a foreign language
fortis one because it will also bring about changes in meaning, cf. dry ­ makes mistakes in the articulation ofparticular sounds. L. V. Shcherba clas­
try, ladder - latter, bid - bit. That is why it is possible to state that occlu­ sifies the pronunciation errors as phonological and phonetic.
sive, forelingual and lenis characteristics of the phoneme [d] are general­ If an allophone of some phoneme is replaced by an allophone of a dif­
ized in the mind of the speaker into what is called the invariant of this ferent phoneme the mistake is called phonological, because the meaning
phoneme. of the word is inevitably affected. It happens when one or more relevant
On the one hand, the phoneme is real, because it is realized in speech features of the phoneme are not realized:
in the material form of speech sounds, its allophones. On the other hand, When the vowel [i:] in the word beat becomes slightly more open, more
it is an abstract language unit. That is why we can look upon the phoneme advanced or is no longer diphthongized the word beat may be perceived as
as a dialectical unity of the material and abstract aspects. Thus we may quite a different word bit. It is perfectly clear that this type of mistakes is
state that it is the material form of speech sounds, its allophones. Speech not admitted in teaching pronunciation to any type of language learner.
sounds are necessarily allophones of one of the phonemes of the language If an allophone of the phoneme is replaced by another allophone of
concerned. All the allophones of the same phoneme have some articula­ the phoneme the mistake is called phonetic. It happens when the invari­
tory features in common, i. e. all of them possess the same invariant. Si­ ant ofthe phoneme is not modified and consequently the meaning of the
multaneously each allophone possesses quite particular phonetic features word is not affected, e. g. :
which may not be traced in the articulation of other allophones of the When the vowel [i:] is fully long in such a word as sheep, for instance,
same phoneme. That is why while teaching pronunciation we cannot ask the quality of it remaining the same, the meaning of the word does not
our students to pronounce this or that phoneme. We can only teach them change. Nevertheless language learners are not to let phonetic mistakes
to pronounce one of its allophones. into their pronunciation. If they do make them the degree of their foreign
The articulatory features which form the invariant of the phoneme are accent will certainly be an obstacle to the listener's perception and under­
called distinctive or relevant. To extract the relevant feature of the pho­ standing.
24 Chapter I. The Functional Aspect of Speech Sounds 1.3. Main Trends in the Phoneme Theory 25

1.2. Transcription good results it is necessary that the learners of English should associate each
relevant difference between the phonemes with special symbols, i. e. each
It is interesting at this stage to consider the system ofphonetic notations phoneme should have a special symbol. If not, the difference between the
which is generally termed "transcription". Transcription is a set of symbols pairs of sounds above may be wrongly associated with vowel length which is
representing speech sounds. The symbolization of sounds naturally differs non-distinctive (redundant) in modern English.
according to whether the aim is to indicate the phoneme, i. e. a functional The other type ofbroad transcription, first used by V. A. Vasilyev, causes
unit as a whole, or to reflect the modifications of its allophones as well. no phonological misunderstanding providing special symbols for all vowel
The International Phonetic Association (IPA) has given an accepted phonemes: [I], [i:], [e], [ee], [a:], [A], [n], [J:], [u], [u:], [3:], [a]. Being a good
inventory of symbols, used in different types of transcription. visual aid this way of notation can be strongly recommended for teaching
The first type ofnotation, the broad or phonemic transcription, provides the pronunciation of English to any audience.
special symbols for all the phonemes of a language. The second type, the But phonemic representation is rather imprecise as it gives too little
narrow or allophonic transcription, suggests special symbols for speech information about the actual speech sounds. It incorporates only as much
sounds, representing particular allophonic features. The broad transcrip­ phonetic information as it is necessary to distinguish the functioning of
tion is mainly used for practical purposes (in EFL teaching and learning, for sounds in a language. The narrow or phonetic transcription incorporates
example), the narrow type serves the purposes of research work. as much phonetic information as the phonetician desires, or as he can
The striking difference among present -day broad transcriptions of Brit­ distinguish. It provides special symbols to denote not only the phoneme as
ish English is mainly due to the varying significance which is attached to a language unit but also its allophonic modifications. The symbol [h] for
vowel quality and quantity. Now we shall discuss two kinds of broad tran­ instance indicates aspirated articulation, cf. [k(h)eIt] - [skeIt]. This type
scription which are used for practical purposes in our country. The first type of transcription is mainly used in research work. Sometimes, however, it
was introduced by D. Jones. He realized the difference in quality as well as may be helpful, at least in the early stages, to include symbols representing
in quantity between the vowel sounds in the words sit and seat, pot and port, allophones in order to emphasize a particular feature of an allophonic
pull and pool, the neutral vowel and the vowel in the word earn. However, he modification, e. g. in the pronunciation of the consonant [1] it is often
aimed at reducing the number of symbols to a minimum and strongly in­ necessary to insist upon the soft and hard varieties of it ("clear" and
sisted that certain conventions should be stated once for all. One of these "dark" variants) by using not only [1] but also [1] (the indication of the
conventions is, for instance, that the above-mentioned long and short vow­ "dark" variant).
els differ in quality as well as in quantity. D. Jones supposed that this con­
vention would relieve us from the necessity of introducing special symbols
to differentiate the quality of these vowels. That is why he used the same 1.3. Main Trends in the Phoneme Theory
symbols for them. According to D. Jones' notation English vowels are de­
noted like this: [I] - [i:], [e] - [ee], [A] - [a:], [J] - [J:], [u] - [u:], [a] - [a:]. Now that we have established what the phoneme is, le.t us view the main
This way of notation disguises the qualitative difference between the vowels trends ofthe phoneme theory. Most linguists agree that the phoneme serves
[I] and [i:], [J] and [J:], [u] and [u:], [a] and [a:] though nowadays most pho­ to distinguish morphemes and words thus being a functional unit. However,
neticians agree that vowel length is not a distinctive feature ofthe vowel, but some ofthem define it in purely "psychological" terms, others prefer phys­
is rather dependent upon the phonetic context, i. e. it is definitely redun­ ically grounded defmitions. Some scholars take into consideration only the
dant. For example, in such word pairs as hit - heat, cock - cork, pull- pool abstract aspect ofthe phoneme, others stick only to its materiality. This has
the opposed vowels are approximately of the same length, the only differ­ divided various "schools" of phonology some of which will be discussed
ence between them lies in their quality which is therefore relevant. below. Views of the phoneme seem to fall into four main classes.
More than that. Phonetic transcription is a good basis for teaching the As you see from the definition of the phoneme suggested above the au­
pronunciation ofa foreign language, being a powerful visual aid. To achieve thors ofthe book share L. V. Shcherba's view, because it is obviously impor­
26 Chapter 1. The Functional Aspect of Speech Sounds .3. Main Trends in the Phoneme Theory 27

tant to look upon the phoneme as a unity of its three aspects: material, ab­ mentioned features are distinctive, lenisness contrasts with fortisness. Some
stract and functional. approaches have taken these oppositions as the basic elements of phono­
The "mentalistic" or "psychological" view regards the phoneme as an logical structure rather than the phonemes in the way the phoneme was
ideal "mental image" or a target at which the speaker aims. Actually pro­ deftned above. The functional approach extracts non-distinctive features
nounced speech sounds are imperfect realizations of the phoneme existing from the phonemes thus divorcing the phoneme from actually pronounced
in the mind but not in the reality. Allophones of the same phoneme cannot speech sounds. This view is shared by many foreign linguists. See in particu­
be alike because of the influence of the phonetic context. lar the works ofN. Trubetskoy (1960), L. BloomfIeld (1933), R. Jakobson,
According to this conception allophones of the phoneme are varying M. Halle (1956), who deftne the phoneme as a bundle of distinctive fea­
materializations of it. This view was originated by the founder of the pho­ tures.
neme theory, the Russian linguist I. A. Baudauin de Courtenay. Similar The functional view of the phoneme gave rise to a branch oflinguistics
ideas were expressed by E. D. Sapir. This point of view was shared by other called "phonology" or "phonemics" which is concerned with relationships
linguists, A. Sommerfelt (Sommerfelt 1936) for one, who described pho­ between contrasting sounds in a language. Its special interest lies in estab­
nemes as "models which speakers seek to reproduce". lishing the system of distinctive features of the language concerned. Pho­
The "psychological", or "mentalistic" view ofthe phoneme was brought netics is limited in this case to the precise description of acoustic and psy­
back into favour by generative phonology, and the idea of the phoneme as a chological aspects ofphysical sounds without any concern to their linguistic
"target" was revived, albeit under different terminology by N. Chomsky function. The supporters of this conception even recommend to extract
Chomsky, M. Halle, 1968), M. Tatham (Tatham 1980) and others. Now phonetics from linguistic disciplines which certainly cannot be accepted by
the basic concepts ofgenerative phonology attract much attention because Russian phoneticians.
of the rapid development of applied linguistics. A stronger form of the "functional" approach is advocated in the so­
The so-called "functional" view regards the phoneme as the minimal called "abstract" view of the phoneme, which regards phonemes as essen­
sound unit by which meanings may be differentiated without much regard tially independent of the acoustic and physiological properties associated
to actually pronounced speech sounds. Meaning differentiation is taken to with them, i. e. of speech sounds. This view ofthe phoneme was pioneered
be a deftning characteristic of phonemes. Thus the absence of palatalization by L. Hjelmslev (1963) and his associates in the Copenhagen Linguistic
in [I] and palatalization of [1] in English do not differentiate meanings, and Circle, H. 1. Uldall and K. Togby.
therefore [I] and [1] cannot be assigned to different phonemes but both form The views of the phoneme discussed above regard the phoneme as an
allophones of the phoneme [1]. The same articulatory features of the Rus­ abstract concept existing in the mind but not in the reality, i. e. in human
sian [n] and [n'] do differentiate meanings, and hence [JI] and [JI'] must be speech, speech sounds being only phonetic manifestations of these con­
assigned to different phonemes in Russian, cf. MOA MOAb, A02 - /lif2. Ac­ cepts.
cording to this conception the phoneme is not a family of sounds, since in The "physical" view regards the phoneme as a "family" of related
every sound only.a certain number of the articulatory features, i. e. those sounds satisfYing certain conditions:
which form the invariant of the phoneme, are involved in the differentiation 1. The various members of the "family" must show phonetic similarity
of meanings. It is the so-called distinctive features of the sound which make to one another, in other words be related in character.
up the phoneme corresponding to it. For example, every sound of the Eng­ 2. No member of the "family" may occur in the same phonetic context
lish word ladder includes the phonetic feature oflenisness but this feature is as any other.
distinctive only in the third sound [d], its absence here would give rise to a The extreme form ofthe "physical" conception as suggested by D. Jones
different word latter, whereas if any other sound becomes fortis the result is (1967) excludes all reference to non-articulatory criteria in the grouping of
merely a peculiar version of ladder. The distinctiveness of such a feature sounds into phonemes. And yet it is not easy to see how sounds could be as­
thus depends on the contrast between it and other possible features belong­ signed to the same phoneme on any other grounds than that substitution of
ing to the same set, i. e. the state of the vocal cords. Thus when the above­ one sound for the other does not give rise to different words and different
28 Chapter L The Functional Aspect of Speech Sounds 104. Methods of Phonological Analysis 29

meaning. The representatives ofthis approach view the phoneme as a group cally different units are identified as "the same" sound, because they have
of similar sounds without any regard to its functional and abstract aspects. similar functions in the language system. In another language community
Summarizing we may state that the conception ofthe phoneme first put they may be classified as different because they perrorm a distinctive func­
forward by L. V. Shcherba may be regarded as the most suitable for the pur­ tion. Consider the following comparison: the two English [1] and·[l] sounds
pose of teaching. (clear and dark) are identified by English people as one phoneme because
the articulatory difference does not affect the meaning. English speakers are
not aware of the difference because it is of no importance in the communi­
1.4. Methods of Phonological Analysis cation process.
In the Russian language a similar, though not identical difference be­
1.4.1. The aim of phonological analysis tween [JI] and [JI'] affects the meaning, like inAYK andAlOK. So these sounds
are identified by Russian speakers as two different phonemes. Analogically,
Now that you have a good idea of what a phoneme is, we shall try to the speakers of Syrian notice the difference between the [th] of English ten
establish the aim of phonological analysis ofspeech sounds, to give an over­ and the [t] of letter, because it is phonemic in Syrian but only allophonic in
view of the methods applied in this sort of analysis and show what charac­ English.
teristics ofthe quality ofsounds are ofprimary importance in grouping them Thus a very important conclusion follows: statements concerning pho­
into functionally similar classes, i. e. phonemes. nological categories and allophonic variants can usually be made of a par­
To study the sounds of a language from the functional point of view ticular language.
means to study the way they function, that is to find out which sounds a So the aim of the phonological analysis is, firstly, to determine which dif­
language uses as part of its pronunciation system, how sounds are grouped ferences of sounds are phonemic and which are non-phonemic and, sec­
into functionally similar units. The final aim of phonological analysis of a ondly, to find the inventory of the phonemes of a language.
language is the identification of the phonemes and finding out the patterns
of relationships into which they fall as parts of the sound system ofthat lan­ 1.4.2. Distributional method of phonological analysis
guage.
There are two ways of analyzing speech sounds: if we define /s/ from the There are two most widely used methods of finding out what sounds are
phonological point of view it would be constrictive foreliIlb'1lal fortis, this contrastive. They are the formally distributional method and the semanti­
would be quite enough to remind us of the general class of realization ofthis cally distributional method.
segment; for articulatory description we would need much more informa­ The formally distributional method consists in grouping all the sounds
tion, that is: what sort of narrowing is formed by the tip of the tongue and pronounced by native speakers into phonemes according to the two laws of
the alveolar ridge, what is the shape of the tongue when the obstruction is phonemic and allophonic distribution. The laws were discovered long ago
made (a groove in the centre of the tongue while the sides form a closure and are as follows:
with the alveolar ridge), and so on. So if the speech sounds are studied from 1. Allophones of different phonemes occur in the same phonetic con­
the articulatory point of view it is the differences and similarities of their text.
production that are in the focus of attention, whereas the phonological ap­ 2. Allophones of the same phoneme never occur in the same phonetic
proach suggests studying the sound system which is actually a set of rela­ context.
tionships and oppositions which have functional The sounds of a laIlb'1lage combine according to a certain pattern charac­
Each language has its own system of phonemes. Each member of the teristic of this language. Phonemic opposability depends on the way the pho­
system is determined by all the other members and does not exist without nemes are distributed in their occurrence. That means that in any language
them. The linguistic value of articulatory and acoustic qualities of sounds is certain sounds do not occur in certain positions, like [h] never occurs word
not identical in different languages. In one language community two physi­ finally while [D] never occurs word initially. Such characteristics permit iden­
30 L The Functional Aspect of Speech Sounds 1.4. Methods of Phonological Analysis 31

tification of phonemes on the grounds of their distribution. Ifa sound occurs rule that phonemes can distinguish words and morphemes when opposed to
in a certain phonetic context and another one occurs in a different phonetic one another. The semantic method of identifying the phonemes of a lan­
context no two words of a language can be distinguished solely by means of guage attaches great significance to meaning. It consists in systemic substi­
the opposition between those two. The two sets ofphonetic contexts are com­ tution of the sound for another in order to ascertain in which cases where
plementing each other and the two sounds are classed as allophones of the the phonetic context remains the same such substitution leads to a change
same phoneme. They are said to be in complementary distribution. Consider of meaning. It is with the help ofthe informant that the change of meaning
the following: ifwe fully palatalize [I] in the word "let" it may sound peculiar is stated. This procedure is called the commutation test. It consists in find­
to native speakers but the word is still recognized as "let" but not "bet" or ing minimal pairs of words and their grammatical forms. By a minimal pair
"pet". The allophones lack distinctive power because they never occur in the we mean a pair ofwords or morphemes which are differentiated by only one
same phonetic context and the difference in their articulation depends on dif­ phoneme in the same phonetic context.
ferent phonetic environment. To be able to distinguish the meaning the same Let's consider the following example: suppose the scholar arrives at the
sounds must be capable ofoccuqing in exactly the same environment like [p] sequence [pin]; he substitutes the sound [p] for the sound [b]. The substitu­
and [b] in "pit" and "bit". Thus two conclusions follow: tion leads to the change of meaning. This proves that [p] and rbl can be re­
I. If more or less diflerent sounds occur in the same phonetic context garded as allophones of different phonemes.
they should be allophones of different phonemes. In this case their distribu­ Minimal pairs are useful for establishing the phonemes
tion is contrastive. If we continue to substitute [p] for [8], [d], [w] we get minimal pairs of
2. If more or less similar sounds occur in different positions and never words with different meaning sin, din, win. So [8], [d], [w] are allophones of
occur in the same phonetic context they are allophones ofone and the same different phonemes. But suppose we substitute [ph] for [p], the pronuncia­
phoneme. In this case their distribution is complementary. word would be wrong from the point ofview of English pronun­
There are cases when allophones are in complementary distribution ciation norm, but the word would be still recognized as pin but not anything
are not referred to the same phoneme. This is the case with the English else. So we may conclude that the unaspirated [p] is an allophone of the
and [lJ]: [h) occurs only initially or before a me­ same
dially or finally after a voweL In this case distribution is mod­ The phonemes ofa language form a system ofoppositions in which any
ified by addition ofthe criterion similarity/dissimilarity. Articu­ phoneme is usually opposed to other phonemes of the language in at least
latory features are taken into account. one position, in at least one minimal pair. So to establish the phonemic
So far we have considered cases when the distribution of sounds was structure of a language it is necessary to establish the whole system of op­
or complementary. There is a third possibility, namely, positions. AU the sounds should be opposed in word-initial, word-medial
sounds occur in the language but the speakers are inconsistent in and word-final positions. There are three kinds of oppositions. If members
the way they use them, like in the case ofthe Russian KGflOlUU - ZGflOlUU. In ofthe opposition differ in one feature the opposition is said to be single, like
such cases we must take them as free variants ofa single phoneme. The rea­ in pen - ben. Common features: occlusive, labiaL Differentiating feature:
son for the variation in the realization of the same phoneme could be ac­ fortis -lenis. Iftwo distinctive features are marked the opposition is said to
counted for by dialect or other social factors .. be double, like in pen den. Common feature: occlusive. Differentiating
features: labial - lingual, fortis voiceless - lenis voiced. If three distinctive
1.4.3. Semantically distributional method of phonological analysis features are marked the opposition is said to be triple (multiple), like in
pen - then. Ditlerentiating features: occlusive constrictive, labial - den­
There is another method of phonological analysis widely used in Rus­ tal, fortis voiceless lenis voiced.
sian linguistics. It is called the semantically distributional method or seman­ The features ofa phoneme that are capable of differentiating the mean­
tic method. It is applied for phonological analysis of both unknown lan­ ing are termed as relevant or distinctive. The ones that do not take part in
guages and languages already described. The method is based on a phonemic differentiating the meaning are termed as irrelevant or non-distinctive. The
32 Chapter 1. The Functional A~pect of Speech Sounds 104. Methods of Phonological Analysis
33

latter can be oftwo kinds: a) incidental or redundant features like aspiration abstract ['cebstrakt] - abstract [ab'strcekt]

ofvoiceless plosives, presence ofvoice in voiced consonants, length ofvow­ conduct ['knndakt] - conduct [kan'dAkt]

els; b) indispensable or concomitant features like tenseness of English long contrast ['kontra:st] - contrast [kan'tra:st]

monophthongs, the checked character of stressed short vowels, lip round­


ing of back vowels. There may be different solutions to the problem of phoneme identifica­
So the phonological analysis of the sounds of a language is based on tion in weak positions of alternated sounds. The problem is by far more
such notions as contrastive distribution, minimal pairs, free variation. To significant for the Russian language because of the widely spread voiced!
voiceless assimilation and vowel reduction in the language:
this we must add one more concept, native speaker's knowledge. All the
rules referred to above should account for the intuition of the native speaker a) MOP03 [MAp6c] MopmbI [MAp63bI]

and that is the real reason why we adopt them. It is the native speaker's feel­ 6) Koca [KAca] KOChl [K6cbI]

ing that makes us treat the allophones of [lJ] and [h] as different phonemes.
Summing up we might say that the phonemic system of a language is Scholars of different trends are not unanimous in treating the problem.
patterned. It is the aim ofphonological analysis to systematize the sounds of The so-called morphological school represented by P. S. Kuznetsov, A. A. Re­
the language, i. e. to group them into functionally similar classes. formatsky, R. 1. Avanesov, v: P. Sidorov, M. v: Panov supported the theory of
neutralization of phonemes, which is said to occur when two or more close­
1.4.4. Methods of establishing the phonemic status of speech sounds ly related sounds which are in contrast with each other in most positions
in weak positions. Morphonology like ",lJ,OM" - "TOM", are found to be non-contrastive in certain other posi­
tions, like in "cy,lJ," [CYT] - CY,lJ,HTb [CY,lJ,'HT']. In such cases the opposition
Continuing the overview of the approaches to establishing the phone­ between the two sounds is said to be neutralized. The loss of one or more
mic status of speech sounds we should consider the cases when the sounds distinctive features of a phoneme in the weak position is called phonemic
are in the weak position, or the position of neutralization. In this position neutralization.
some of the distinctive features are neutralized. For vowels it is the position Moscow philologists claim that the interchange ofsounds manifests close
in the unstressed syllables. Consonants are in their strong position before connection between phonetics as the science of the sound system and mor­
vowels and in the intervocalic position, they are in the weak position when phology of the language which studies grammatical meanings. Alternations
they are word final or precede other consonants. are observed in one and the same morphological units, in a morpheme, and
This problem is tackled by morphonology or morphophonemics, which actualize the phonemic structure of the morpheme. Thus, the phonemic
studies the relationship between phonemes and morphemes. Morphonolo­ content of the morpheme is constant. The supporters of the morphological
gy is concerned with the way in which sounds can alternate as different re­ trend defme the phoneme as follows: «3TO .pYHKUI10HaJIhHaH .poHem'fe­
alization of one and the same morpheme. A morpheme is a minimal unit of CKaH e,lJ,I1HMua, rrpe,lJ,CTaBJIeHHaH PMOM rr03HUHOHHO 'fepe,11,YIOlIJ,l1XCH
meaning. Consider the words "windy", "dusty", "sunny". Evidently they 3BYKOB)} (I1aHoB, 1979: 107).
have two morphemes. The meaning of "wind", "dust", "sun" is obvious. The notion of «.poHemqeCKHH PM», suggested by R. f. Avanesov, dem­
But what function does the morpheme "-y" perform? It appears that the onstrates positionally determined realizations of the phoneme. Positionally
function of"-y" is to convert a noun into an adjective. This morpheme has alternating sounds are grouped into one phoneme even if they are similar or
a grammatical meaning. Now then what is meant by the identification of have common features (that is common allophones) with other phonemes.
alternated sounds? The Russian preposition «c» + noun may have the following realizations:
The following pairs of words exemplifY a sound alternation in one and
c KOJIeH [c] c illypoH [rn]

the same morpheme of two different parts of speech.


c TMMornen: [c'] c )KeHen: [)K]

malice [,mcehs] - malicious [ma'hjas] c faJIen: [3] c qYKOM [rn:]

active [,cektIv] - activity [ak'tIVltI] c,lJ;HMOH [3']


34 Chapter T. The Functional Aspect of Speech Sounds 1.5. The System of English Phonemes 35

In the morphological conception the alternations of the phonemes are or intermittent blockage of the air passage by a speech organ. As a result
not analyzed apart from the morphemes, as form and content make a dia­ consonants are sounds which have noise as their indispensable and most
lectical unity. The phonetic system is not isolated from the grammatical and defining characteristic.
lexical structure of the language, and the unity between the form and the Now we shall consider each class of sounds independently.
content cannot be destroyed. Yet as an answer to the problem it is not en­
tirely satisfactory since ordinary speakers are in no doubt that the sound 1.5.1. The system of consonants
that occurs in the above-mentioned combinations is the preposition «c».
St. Petersburg phonological school (L. R. Zinder, M. I. Matysevitch) as­ On the articulatory level each consonant may be identified by stating
sert that the phoneme is independent of the morpheme. SO [A] in «Bo,Ua» two general facts about it:
belongs to the [a] phoneme while [0] in «BO,UhI» to the [0] phoneme; [c] in 1) what sort of articulatory posture it is formed by;
the word «MOP03» belongs to the [c] morpheme and [3] in «MOP03bI» - to 2) whereabout in the vocal tract it is produced.
the [3] phoneme respectively. The supporters of this conception claim that Besides these major characteristics the particular quality ofa consonant
the phoneme cannot lose any of its distinctive features. may depend on a lot of factors, i. e. by what articulatory organ (or organs)
As far as the English language is concerned, the neutral sound [a] in the an obstruction is made, how the vocal cords work at the moment of produc­
word "activity" and the sound [;:e] in the words "act", "active" is the [;:e] tion, what cavity is used as a resonator, what is the force of articulatory
phoneme. It seems that according to this point of view the unity between fort and many others. So in our view the particular quality of a consonant
the form and the content is destroyed, thus phonology is isolated from mor­ would be best thought of as a complex bundle of features. Each sound is
phology. known to have three aspects: articulatory; acoustic and auditory; and there­
In conclusion we have to admit that the described conceptions are arbi­ fore can be studied on three levels. For the sake of analysis each aspect can
trary, none is ideal. The morphological conception seems complicated, but be considered and described independently, though it is obvious that there
appears to be effective for theory and practice. is no sharp dividing line between them.
Trying to work out a classification ofsuch complex units as speech sounds
one should specifY those properties ofsounds which are relevant to the subject
1.5. The System of English Phonemes under discussion, so the attempts to classifY sounds should have a theoretical
foundation. Besides, each classification should not only aim at linguistic de­
In this section we are going to give a brief overview of the problems scription but should be applicable in teaching a language. Therefore the clas­
which scholars face when trying to describe the English sounds from the sification should include if possible both the principal relevant features and
functional point of view. We shall try to explain what is understood by the the ones that are redundant from the phonological point of view; but are im­
quality of a sound, what articulatory characteristics may be considered the portant for the articulation ofthe sound. Here we should say that the phono­
constituents of quality and to determine which of them are phonologically logical description ofsounds will be made in terms ofarticulatory leveL
relevant. It is suggested that the first and basic principle of classification is the
There are two major classes of sounds traditionally distinguished by degree of noise. It leads to dividing English consonants into two big
phoneticians in any language. They are termed consonants and vowels. The groups:
distinction is based mainly on auditory effect. Consonants are known to A - noise consonants;
have voice and noise combined, while vowels are sounds consisting ofvoice B - sonorants.
only. From the articulatory point ofview the difference is due to the work of It is easy to see that the term "degree of noise" belongs to auditory level
speech organs. In the production of vowels no obstruction is made. In the analysis. But it is generally acknowledged that there is an intrinsic con­
production ofconsonants various obstructions are made. So consonants are nection between articulatory and auditory aspects of describing speech
characterized by the so-called close articulation, i. e. by a complete, partial sounds, so that sometimes it is impossible to account for the former except
36 Chapter 1. The Functional Aspect of Speech Sounds
1.5. The System of English Phonemes 37
in terms of the latter. In the above mentioned case it is the terms of auditory
Figure 5
level that defme the characteristic more adequately.
Sonorants are consonants that phoneticians traditionally have a lot of ar­ consonants
guments about. Sonorants are sounds that differ greatly from all other conso­
nants of the language. This is due to the fact that in their production the air
passage is fairly wide, much wider than in the production of noise conso­ sonorants
nants. As a result the auditory effect is tone, not noise. This peculiarity of ar­
ticulation makes sonorants sound more like vowels than consonants. Acous­
occlusive­
tically sonorants are opposed to an other consonants because they are constrictive
characterized by a sharply defined formant structure and the total energy of
most of them is very high. However, on functional grounds according to their
position in the syllable sonorants are included in the consonantal category.
The great articulatory and acoustic difference of noise consonants and
sonorants could be very well relied upon as having classificatory value. The
The place ofarticulation is another characteristic ofEnglish consonants
phonological relevance of this factor (the degree of noise) could be proved
which we should consider from the phonological point ofview. The place of
by the following oppositions:
articulation is determined by the active organ of speech against the point of
[berk - merk] bake make (noise consonant - sonorant) articulation. According to this principle the English consonants are classed
[vi:l- wi:l] veal - wheel (noise consonant sonorant) into:
1) labial;

The manner of the production of noise and the type of obstruction is 2) lingual;

another characteristic of English consonants. On this ground three classes 3) glottal.

of consonants are distinguished:


The class of labial consonants is subdivided into: a) bilabial; b) labio­
a) occlusive, in the production of which a complete obstruction is
dental, and among the class of lingual consonants three subclasses are dis­
formed;
tinguished. They are: a) forelingual; b) mediolingual and c) backlingual.
b) constrictive, in the production ofwhich an incomplete obstruction is
The classification of consonants according to this principle is illustrated
formed; I he following scheme:
c) occlusive-constrictive consonants (affricates), in the production of
Figure 6
which the obstruction is complete at the beginning of production, then it
becomes incomplete.
The phonological relevance of this feature could be exemplified in the
following oppositions:
[ti:] [si: ] tea sea (occlusive constrictive)
glottal
[si:d] [si:z] seed ­ seas (occlusive - constrictive)
[ti:z] ­ [tJi:z] tease ­ cheese (occlusive - afIricate)
[si:z] - [si:d3] cease siege (constrictive - atIricate)
labio-dental mediolingual backlingual
[pefS] - [perd3] pace - page (constrictive - affricate)
The following scheme might be helpful to understand the system built in
The importance of this characteristic as phonologically relevant could
accordance with the above-mentioned order ofarticulatory characteristics:
he proved by means of a sjmple example. In the system of English conso­
38 Chapter 1. The Functional Aspect of Speech Sounds 1.5. The System of English Phonemes 39

nants there could be found oppositions based on the active organ of speech LO this principle consonants can be oral and nasal. There are relatively few
and the place of obstruction: consonantal types in English which require a lowered position of the soft
palate. They are the nasal occlusive sonorants [m], [n], and [uJ. No differ­
[p~nJ - [t~nJ pan-tan (bilabial ­ forelingual) ence of meaning in English can be attributed to the presence or absence of
[walJ ­ [lalJ why lie (bilabial forelingual) nasalisation. It is for this reason that it cannot be a phonologically relevant
[plk] [klk] pick- kick (bilabial- backlingual) Ii~ature of English consonants. So it is an indispensable concomitant feature
[les J - [jes] less yes (forelingual mediolingual) of English nasal consonants.
[del] ­ [gel] day-gay (forelingual- backlingual) Summarizing we could state that the following articulatory features are
[salJ - [hal] sigh - high (forelingual glottal) considered to be relevant from phonological point ofview:
[fi:t] - [si:t] feet - seat (labio-dental- fore lingual) I) type of obstruction;
Another sound property is voiced - voiceless characteristic which de­ 2) place of articulation and active organ of speech;
pends on the work ofthe vocal cords. It has long been believed that from the 3) force of articulation.
articulatory point of view the distinction between such pairs of consonants The above mentioned articulatory characteristics are the primary ones
as [p, b], [t, d], [k, g], [s, z], [f, v], [I, 3], [tf, d3J is based on the absence or as they specify the essential quality of a consonant which is enough to de­
presence of the vibrations of the vocal cords or on the absence or presence scribe it as an item of a system. On this level of analysis it is the point where
of voice or tone component. However, a considerable body of experimental the distinction becomes phonemic that matters.
work on physiological and acoustic aspects ofthese sounds showed that this However, from the point of view of pronunciation teaching we should
is not the only difference between them. It is obvious now that there is also gain some additional information about the articulation ofa consonant like
energy difference. All voiced consonants are weak (lenis) and all voiceless apical- dorsal; dental, alveolar, post-alveolar, palato-alveolar; oral- nasal;
consonants are strong (fortis). Now there is a considerable controversy con­ flat narrowing - round narrowing characteristics. They provide necessary
cerning the phonetic feature involved in the above-mentioned oppositions. information for comparison between the English and Russian consonants.
In the intervocalic position, like in "latter - ladder" the voicing difference It is for this reason that these characteristics are normally included into de­
is important, since it is the distinctive feature of the consonants. In word scriptions.
initial and word final positions the pronunciation of consonants tradition­
ally considered to be voiced may well be voiceless. In these positions it is the 1.5.2. The system ofvowels
energy difference that serves as a differenciating feature, like in "cap - cab",
"not nod", "pick - pig". In initial positions aspiration would be a more As was mentioned earlier, vowels unlike consonants are produced with
important feature for stops, like in "tick - dick", "cap - gap", "pit - bit". no obstruction to the stream of air, so on the perception level their integral
In a word-final position it is the length of the preceding vowel that would characteristic is tone not noise.
constitute the chief difference (the vowel of "bead" is longer than that of A minimal vowel system of a language is likely to take the form of:
"beet").
It is perfectly obvious that the presence or absence ofvoice in the above­
mentioned oppositions is not a constant distinctive feature. Thus it may be
said that these oppositions are primarily based on energy difference, i. e. on
fortis lenis articulation, which are phonologically relevant features. It is
for this reason that such characteristics as voiceless - voiced have given The most important characteristic ofthese vowels is that they are acous­
place to "fortis lenis" distinction. tically stable. They are known to be entirely different from one another both
There is one more articulary characteristic which is important from articulatory and acoustically. Consequently they may well be said to form
classificatory point ofview, that is the position of the soft palate. According boundaries ofthe"phonetic field ofvowels" in modern man's language. The
40 Chapter 1. The Functional Aspect of Speech Sounds .5. The System of English Phonemes 41

commonest vowel system adds two other vowels to the minimum triangle to (:onsists of two clearly perceptible elements. There exists a third variety; an
give a five vowel system of the type: intennediate case, when the change in the tongue position is fairly weak. So
according to the principle of stability of articulation the English vowels are
divided
monophthongs;
b) diphthongs;
c) diphthongoids.
As regards the English language it would be fair to mention that due to point ofview is not shared by British phoneticians. A. Gimson, for
various reasons it has developed a vocalic system of a much larger number example, doesn't distinguish between monophthongs and diphthongoids,
of phonemes. considering the latter to be pure vowels.
The quality of a vowel is known to be detennined by the size, volume and English diphthongs are monophonemic units, while Russian combina­
the shape ofthe mouth resonator which are modified by the movement ofac­ tions of sounds are byphonemic clusters, like in: IOZ, pau, 6ya/lb and so on.
tive speech organs, i. e. the tongue and the lips. Besides, the particular quality Both elements in the clusters are equally energetic and distinct. So special
of a vowel can depend on a lot of other factors (articulatory characteristics) attention should be given to the pronunciation of English diphthongs which
such as the relative stability of the tongue, the position of the lips, physical consist oftwo elements, the first ofwhich is strong and distinct and the sec­
duration of the segment, the force of articulation, the degree of tenseness of ond, the glide, is very weak and indistinct.
speech organs. So vowel quality could be thOUght of as a bundle definite The position ofthe tongue, another principle for consideration, is char­
articulatory characteristics which are sometimes interconnected and interde­ acterized from two aspects: horizontal and vertical movement.
pendent: the back position of the tongue makes it rise higher in the mouth According to the horizontal movement five classes of vowels are distin­
cavity, the lengthening of a vowel makes the organs of speech tenser at the guished:
moment of production and so on. So the isolation and distinction of the 1) front: [i:], [e], [~], [£(a)];
above-mentioned articulatory features are made for the sake of analysis with 2) front retracted: [I), [I(a)];
the purpose of describing the vocalic system of the English language. 3) central: [3:], [a], [3(U)], [a(u)J, [a(I)];
The analysis of the articulatory constituents of the quality of vowels al­ . back: [n], [;:,:J, [u:J, [a:], [;:,(r)];
lowed phoneticians to suggest the criteria for classificatory description. 5) back adVanced: [u], [u(a)].
They are:
According to the vertical movement three classes of vowels are distin­
a) stability of articulation
guished, each ofwhich is realized in one ofthe two variants, broad or narrow:
b) tongue position I) close a) narrow:
c) lip position
b) broad: [1], [u], [r(a)],
d) character ofthe vowel end 2) mid a) narrow: [eJ; [3:], [3(U)];
e) length
b) broad: [a],
1) tenseness 3) open a) narrow: [;:,:], [;:'(1)];
In the part that follows each of the above-mentioned factors will be
b) broad: [~], [a(r)], [n], [a:].
considered from phonological point ofview.
Stability of articulation specifies the actual position of the articulating The phonological relevance of this articulatory characteristic can be
organ in the process ofthe articulation ofa vowel. easily discovered in the following oppositions:
There are two possible varieties: a) the tongue position is stable; b) it [pen p~n] pen pan [k~p - ku:p] cap - carp

changes, that is the tongue moves from one position to another. In the first pm] pen pin [k~p - kAp] cap - cup

case the articulated vowel is relatively pure, in the second case the vowel - bi:n] bin - been [bAn - ba:nJ bun - barn

Chapter 1. The Functional Aspect of Speech Sounds I's. The System of English Phonemes 43
42

Lip rounding is another articulatory feature which is included into the 4) the position of the sound in a syllable;
principles of classification of English vowels. Traditionally three lip posi­ 5) the position in a rhythmic group;
tions are distinguished: spread, neutral and rounded. For the purpose of 6) the position in a tone group;
classification it is sufficient to distinguish between two lip positions: round­ 7) the position in a phrase;
ed and unrounded or neutral. In English lip rounding is not relevant phono­ 8) the position in the utterance;
logically since no two words can be differentiated on its basis. Lip rounding 9) the tempo ofthe whole utterance;
takes place rather due to psychological reasons than to any other. The fact is 10) the type of pronunciation;
that any vowel in English is produced with rounded lips, the degree of 11) the style of pronunciation.
rounding is different and depends on the height of the raised part of the
The question is whether vowel length can be treated as a relevant feature
tongue. So lip rounding is a phoneme constitutive indispensable feature be­ of the English vowel system.
cause no back vowel can exist without it.
The theoretical conclusion here is based on two laws characterizing any
Another property of English vowel sounds is traditionally termed check­ system.
ness. This quality depends on the character of transition from a vowel to a, l. A relevant feature must characterize a number of units. Let us con­
consonant. This kind of transition is very close in English unlike Russian. sider palatalization in Russian. Compare: ell - eJlb, pao PIlO, Hoe - H06b
As a result all English short vowels are checked when stressed. The degree of so on. Those oppositions form a correlation system. Any correlation
checkness may vary and depends on the following consonants. Before have a number of oppositions. A sign of correlation is a distinctive
voiceless consonant it is more perceptible than before a lenis voiced conso­ rcature ofa number of phonemes. The analysis of English vowels shows that
nant or sonorant. All long vowels are free. Lhey can hardly form quantitative correlation. The correlations that are of­
It is important to know that though this characteristic has no phono­ len brought about are as follows:
logical value it is of primary importance for Russian learners of English. It [I] [i:]
should be remembered that since all Russian vowels are free, special atten­ [u] [u:]
tion should be given to making English short vowels checked. It is not the [A] [a:]
length of vowels that should be the point of attention but the character of
the transition of a vowel into a consonant. Such words as body, seven, better,
matter should be divided into syllables in such a way so that the vowels Let us analyze each of these pairs.
should remain checked unlike Russian EOPIl, Ce6a, Puma, MIlma. In actual speech the sounds [i:] and [u:] are normally realized in RP as
Length or quantity of vowels is another articulatory characteristic that diphthongized vowels. So [1] and [u] are opposed to diphthongoids but not
should be considered from phonological point of view. to long monophthongs.
The English monophthongs are traditionally divided into two classes The opposition [3:1- [a] is a fairly specific one because the [a] phoneme
never occurs in a stressed syllable and forms the core ofunstressed vocalism
according to their length:
a) short vowels: [I], [e], [;:e], [u], [A], [a], [n];
in English. The phoneme [3:] seldom occurs in an unstressed position.
b) long vowels: [i:], [a:], [;):], [3:], [u:].
The opposition [a:] - [A] is arbitrary. As a result there is only one pair of
It is common knowledge that a vowel like any sound has physical duration ­ opposed phonemes remaining, [;):] [n]. That means that quantitative cor­
time which is required for its production. When sounds are used is connected relation exists only in one position, so on this ground it cannot be treated as
speech they are influenced by one another. Duration is one ofthe characteristics a phonologically relevant feature.
ofa vowel which is modified by and depends on the following factors: 2. A feature can be systemic ifit does not depend on the context. As to the
absolute length of English historically long and historically short vowels it var­
1) its own length;

ies and depends on a lot offactors, the first being phonetic context. A. C. Gim­
2) the accent of the :'Vlli::lUlv

son points out that [i:] in beat is only half about as long as the fi:l of bee and
3) phonetic context;

,5. The System of English Phonemes 45


Chapter 1. The Fu~ctional Aspect of Speech Sounds
44
I \nglish sounds are significant in making them items of a system. Special
may approximately have the same duration as the [I] vowel in bid because it is (beus should be given to phonologically relevant features because they form
generally known that a voiced consonant following a vowel increases its (he basis of the pronunciation system of the language. Non-relevant indis­
length. But still the words bid and bead are perceived as different words be­ pensable features should also be acquired as they form the basis of what is
cause the vowels are different in quality, [I] being front-retracted, pure t'ulled a "foreign accent". \\Ie should remember that the quality of a speech
monophthong, and [i:] being front close (narrow variation) and a diphthon­ tiuund is constituted by articulatory features of both kinds.
gized vowel. The conclusion that follows is that vowel quantity cannot be
considered a minimal distinctive feature since it varies under the influence of
1.5.3. Modifications of speech sounds in connected speech
different phonetic context. So it is an incidental feature that characterizes
vowels of a certain quality. Summarizing we may say that this is an approach In connected speech sounds do not function as isolated units, theIr ar­
to quantity of English vowels from phonological point ofview. Ikulation is affected by their phonetic environment. In other words, speech
It may be worth mentioning that the [ee] vowel being classed as histori­ Nounds influence each other in the chain ofspeech. Modifications ofspeech
cally short tends to be lengthened in Modern English, especially before floLlnds that occur due to this influence are called assimilation, accomoda­
lenis consonants [b], [d], [g], [d3], [m], [nl, [z].ln this position [ee] has the lion and elision.
same quantity as long vowels [i:], [a:], [J:], [u:], [3:]. This extra length, as Assimilation is the modification of a consonant under the influence of
A. C. Gimson points out, serves an additional distinctive feature and the t lie neighbouring consonant. Accommodation is the process ofmutual influ­
qualitative-quantitative relation of [ee] - [e] tends to become of the same ence of consonants and vowels. Elision is a complete reduction of sounds,
type as [i:] [I]. From this point ofview [ee] can possibly belong to the sub­ vowels and consonants.
class of long vowels, and consequently the twelve English long vowel pho­ These processes are generally accounted for by two factors. The first is
nemes may be divided into six phonetic pairs which members differ both in (hc economy ofpronouncing efforts on the part ofthe speaker, whose aim is
quality and in quantity and of the two factors it is likely that the quality car­ lu convey information effectively within the shortest possible time. The sec­
ries the greater contrastive weight. ond is purely physiological: it is the degree of mobility of particular organs
There is one more articulatory characteristic that requires our attention. or speech. Under the influence of these factors segments undergo certain
That is tenseness. It characterizes the state ofthe organs ofspeech at the moment dlanges and all sorts of simplifications take place. It should be mentioned
ofthe production ofvowels. Special instrumental analysis shows that historically Ihat these phonetic modifications do not affect the meaning of utterances
long vowels are tense while historically short vowels are lax. This characteristic is lind do not create barriers in communication, since they are perceived by
of extra-phonological type so tenseness may be considered an indispensable (he listener as normal allophonic realisations. However, foreign learners of
concomitant feature ofEnglish long vowels. On these grounds it can be included I (nglish should be aware of phonetic adjustments in connected speech, be­
into classificatory description of vowels because it might be helpful in teaching l;llUse ignoring them may lead to a strong accent.
students ofEnglish since there are no tense vowels in Russian.
Summarizing we could say that phonological analysis of articulatory
1.5.3.1. Modifications of consonants
features of English vowels allows us to consider as functionally relevant the
following one characteristic: tongue position. In modern English consonants undergo various qualitative changes in
The rest of the features mentioned above, i. e.lip position, character of (lie chain of speech. The most common type of such changes is assimila­
vowel end, length and tenseness are indispensable constituents of vowel I ion. Assimilation takes place when a consonant is adjusted in order to be­
quality. Though they have no phonological value they are quite important in t~()me more like a neighbouring sound. Assimilation occurs both within a
teaching English phonetics. word and at word boundaries. Assimilation can affect the place of articula­
We might conclude by saying that we have tried to look at the consonan­ tion, manner of articulation, work of the vocal cords and force of articula­
tal and vocalic systems of the English language from phonological point of Iion, lip position.
view. This sort of analysis enables us to defme what properties displayed by
46 Chapter I. The Functional Aspect of Speech Sounds 1.5. The System Phonemes 47
,~\

Changes in the place ofarticulation lated to the initial voiceless fortis consonant of the following word: she's
jive, have to do it, does Pete like it? It should be noted that only fricatives
1. The alveolar allophones [t, d, n, 1] are replaced by dental variants when

are affected by this type of assimilation, while plosives [b, d, g] remain


followed by the interdental [8, (j] (incomplete regressive assimilation):

voiced in similar context, big size, goodfellow.


eighth, at the, breadth, on the, all that. 3. Contracted forms of the verbs "is" and "has" may retain voice or be
2. The alveolar [t, d] become post-alveolar under the influence ofthe post­
(incomplete assimilation): tree, true, dry, the third
devoiced depending on the preceding consonant (incomplete progres­
sive assimilation): that's [5] right; Tom's [z] gone; Jack's [s] done it.
Assimilative voicing and devoicing can also be observed in the pro­
3. [5, z] turn into UJ before [J] (complete regressive assimilation): horse
nunciation of the possessive suffix's or s', the plural suffix of nouns (e)s
shoe, ['h::>:JJu'], this shop _ and the third person singular Present Simple of verbs: girl's, beds, reads,
4. Nasal sonorants [n, m] are influenced by the following consonant: bila­
bial [m] and alveolar [n] become labio-dental when followed by labio­
Pete's, desks, writes.
dental [f, v]: triumph, infant, comfort, symphony. [n] becomes palato­ Changes in the
alveolar before the affricate [tf], pinch; in thank it assimilates to the velar
When followed by the bilabial sonorant [w] consonants change their lip
[k] and becomes velar.
position: they become labialized: twinkle, quite, swan.
Changes in the manner ofarticulation There are also adjusment processes that are a result of the consonant ­
vowel interaction. They are generally described as accommodation or con­
1. Loss ofplosion. In the sequence oftwo plosive consonants the first los­
sonant vowel coarticulation. Here are some most common types of ac­
es its plosion (incomplete regressive assimilation): glad to see you,
comodation.
great trouble, an old clock, big cat. Consonants tend to be labialized when followed by a rounded
2. Nasal plosion. When a plosive is followed by nasal sonorants [m, n], at
alzed) vowel: cool, pot, rude.
the release stage the soft palate is lowered and the air escapes through
Vowels are slightly nazalized under the influence ofthe preceding or fol­
the nasal cavity with a slight plosion (incomplete regressive assimila­
lowing sonorants [m] and [n]: and, nice, men, morning.
tion): sudden, not now, at night, let me see.
Alveolar plosive [tl in the intervocal position before unstressed vowels is
3. Lateral plosion. In the sequence ofa plosive immediately followed by
replaced by a voiced tap: pretty, better.
lateral sonorant [1] the release is made with lowering of the sides
of the tongue and the air escapes along the sides of the tongue with
It should be noted that the allophonic realizations of phonemes can be
described as obligatory for all the members of the language community re­
lateral plosion: settle, table, at last (incomplete regressive assimila­
gardless of the style of speech. It is obvious that the extent to which coar­
tion). ticulation and simplification processes are displayed in connected speech
Changes in the work ofthe vocal cords depends on the style and tempo of speech. In formal speech the articulation
is more careful and precise. In informal casual discourse (fast colloquial
This type of assimilation affects the work of the vocal cords and

speech) these processes are more marked. They will be described in Chap­
force of articulation.
lerv'
1. English sonorants [m, n, r, w, 1] are partially devoiced when preceded by
fortis voiceless consonants [p, t, k, 5] (incomplete progressive assimila­
tion): smart, tray, quick, twins, play, pride. This type of assimilation is 1.5.3.2. Modifications ofvowels
common in English, but very rare in Russian. The phonetic process that affects English vowels in connected speech is
2. Fortis voiceless/lenis voiced type regressive assimilation can be observed
called reduction. By vowel reduction we mean shortening or weakening of
in such words as newspaper (news [z] + paper), gooseberry (goose [5] +
I he sound, or, in other words, shortening in length that is usually accompa­
berry). At word boundaries voiced lenis fricatives are commonly assimi­
Chapter 1. The Functional Aspect of Speech Sounds Sununary 49
48

nied by a change in quality. \bwel reduction in unstressed syllables is very The phoneme performs the distinctive function. The opposition ofpho­
nemes in the same phonetic environment differentiates the meaning of
common both in English and in Russian.
In connected speech vowels can be exposed either to quantitative and morphemes and words.
qualitative reduction or both. These changes of vowels are determined by a The phoneme is realized in speech in the form of speech sounds, its al­
number of factors, such as the position ofa vowel in a word and in an utter­ lophones. Allophones of the same phoneme possess similar articulatory
features. The difference between the allophones is predictable and is the
ance, accentual structure, rhythm, tempo of speech.
Quantitative reduction or shortening of vowel length takes place in the result of the influence of the neighbouring sounds.
The actually pronounced speech sounds (phones) are modified by pho­
following cases: nostylistic, dialectal and individual factors.
1. The length of vowel depends on the immediate phonetic environment
(positional length). Vowels are the longest in the final position, they Native speakers abstract themselves from the difference between the al­
are shorter before a voiced consonant and the shortest in a syllable lophones of the same phoneme because it has no functional value but they
closed by a voiceless consonant, knee - need - neat. have a generalized idea ofa complex ofdistinctive features, which cannot be
2. Long vowels in form words are shortened in unstressed positions: At last changed without the change of meaning. This functionally relevant bundle
ofarticulatory features is called the invariant ofthe phoneme.
he [i'] has come. The articulatory features which distinguish meaning and form the in­
Modifications in quality occur in unstressed positions. The most
common form of vowel reduction is reduction to schwa [a]. In its pro­ variant of the phoneme are called distinctive or relevant. The articulatory
duction the tongue is the closest to the neutral position, the lips are features which do not serve to distinguish meaning are called non-distinc­
unrounded and it is the shortest of all vowels. The pronunciation of tive or irrelevant.
schwa instead of some other vowel saves articulatory effort and time. Transcription is a set of symbols representing speech sounds. Broad (or
Man [meen] sportsman ['sp;:dsman], conduct ['knndakt] - conduct phonemic) transcription provides special symbols for all the phonemes of a
language and is used in EFL teaching. Narrow or allophonic transcription
[kan'dAkt]. You can easily do it [ju' kan i:zrlI ,du
Schwa is considered to be the most frequent sound in English. It gives special symbols for allophones and is mainly used in research.
is obviously the result of the rhythmic pattern in which stressed sylla­ There exist various conceptions of the phoneme which can be grouped
bles alternate with unstressed ones. Unstressed syllables are given only into the following main classes: "psychological" or "mentalistic" view (spe­
a short duration and the vowel in them is reduced. cial attention is given to the abstract aspect of the phoneme), "functional"
3. Vowels are slightly nasalized when preceded or followed by a nasal con­ view (concentrates on the ability of the phoneme to distinguish meaning),
"physical" view (is concerned with the material aspect). The conception of
sonant like in man, no, then, mean.
We would like to conclude by saying that certain interrelation the phoneme first put forward by L. V Shcherba is a comprehensive one: it
which we observe between the full form of a vowel and its reduced gives equal importance to the three aspects of the phoneme.
forms is conditioned by the tempo, rhythm and style of speech. The aim ofthe phonological analysis is, firstly, to determine the distinc­
tive features of sounds (or their phonemic status) and, secondly, to create
the inventory ofthe phonemes ofa language (the phonemic system of a lan­
guage). In other words, phonological analysis is aimed at identifYing the
Summary phonemes and classifying them.
The phoneme is a minimal abstract linguistic unit realized in speech in There are two methods of phonological analysis: formally distributional
the form of speech sounds opposable to other phonemes of the same lan­ method and semantically distributional method. Formally distributional
guage to distinguish the meaning of morphemes and words. method is focused on the position ofa sound in the word, or its distribution.
According to this definition the phoneme is a unity of three aspects: The semantically distributional (semantic) method is based on the phone­
mic rule that phonemes can distinguish words and morphemes when op­
functional, material and abstract.
Chapter I. The Functional Aspect of Speech Sounds Chapter II
50

posed to one another in the same phonetic context. The main procedure is SYLLABIC STRUCTURE OF ENGLISH WORDS
called commutation test. It consists in finding minimal pairs of words and
their grammatical forms, i. e. pairs of words or morphemes which differ in
only one sound in the same phonetic context. To establish the phonemic
structure of a language it is necessary to establish the whole system of op­ 2.1. The Phenomenon of the Syllable
positions. All the sounds should be opposed in word-initial, word-medial
2.2. Syllable Formation
and word-final positions. 2.3. Syllable Division (Phonotactics)
There are special difficulties in establishing the phonemic status of
2.4. Functional Aspect ofthe Syllable
sounds in their weak position. This problem is approached in different ways
by the Moscow and St. Petersburg phonological schools.
The application of phonological analysis shows that English phonemes
are grouped into classes according to the distinctive (phonemic) features.
The following features are distinctive for consonants: type of obstruction
(manner of articulation), place of articulation and active organ of speech
and force of articulation. The phonemic feature of vowels is vowel quality
(tongue position). 2.1. The Phenomenon of the Syllable
The articulation ofsounds in connected speech is affected by their pho­
netic environment. Speech sounds influence each other in the chain of
This chapter is concerned with the syllable as a phonetic and phono­
speech. Modifications of speech sounds that occur due to this influence are
logical unit.
called assimilation, accommodation, reduction and elision. It is generally known that speech is a continuum. However it can be
broken into minimal pronounceable units into which sounds show a ten­
dency to cluster or group themselves. These smallest phonetic groups are
given the names of syllables. Being the smallest pronounceable units, the
syllables are capable of forming language units of greater magnitude, 1. e.
morphemes, words and phrases. Each of these units is characterized by a
certain syllabic structure. Consequently we might say that a meaningful lan­
guage unit has two aspects: syllable formation and syllable division which
form a dialectical unity.
Figure 7
Two Aspects of the Syllable

syllable fonnation syllable division

Before we look at the English syllable in detail we should note that the
study of the syllable has for a long time occupied an important place in Iin­
52 Chapter II. Syllabic Structure of English Words It Division (Phonotactics) 53

guistics as a field of theoretical investigation. A considerable body of ex­ 2.2. Syllable Formation
perimental work has been done but we have to admit that the problem ofthe .
syllable is still an open question in linguistics and phonetics. In English syllable formation is based on the phonological opposition
The point is that the syllable is a fairly complicated phenomenon and vowel - consonant. Vowels are usually syllabic while consonants are not
like the phoneme it can be studied on four levels: acoustic, articulatory, au­ with the exception of [1), [m], [n], which become syllabic if they occur in an
ditory and functional and so it can be approached from different points of IInstressed final position, proceeded by a noise consonant, for example
view. This fact gave rise to a number oftheories the most consistent ofwhich Illlt!] -little, ['blusm] blossom, [,ga:dn] garden.
are: the so-called expiratory theory, experimentally proved by R. H. Stetson; The structure of the syllable is known to vary because of the number and
the sonority theory put forward by O. Jespersen; the theory of muscular ten- . HITangement of consonants. In English four types of syllables are distin­
sion which wa<; sketched by L. V. Sherba and modified by V. A. Vasilyev, and guished:
the loudness theory, worked out by N. I. Zhinkin. Each of these theories is
1) open noCV
(in either explicit or implicit way) based on the idea of pulses the structure
2) closed [ud] odd VC
of which form what can be called an arc which correlates with the level of
3) covered note CV(C)
speech production and can be identified on the level of perception.
4) uncovered [30] oh, [30k] oakV(C)
Since the syllable is not a simple concept no phonetician has successed
so far in giving an exhaustive and adequate explanation of what the syllable Here we should point out that due to its structure the English language
is. In short, there exist two points of view: developed the closed type of syllable as the fundamental one while in
1. Some linguists consider the syllable to be a purely articulatory unit Russian it is the open type that forms the basis of syllable formation. The
which lacks any functional value. This point of view is defended on the II umber ofthe syllable structural varieties is 23. The structure ofthe English
grounds that the boundaries of the syllable do not always coincide with syllable reveals variations in the number of prevocalic consonants from I
those ofthe morphemes. to 3 and post vocalic consonants from I to 5.
2. However the majority of linguists treat the syllable as the smallest As to the number ofsyllables in the English word it can vary from one to
pronounceable unit which can reveal some linguistic function. oight, like in [kAm] come, ['SIb] city, [,fcem(a)li]jamily, fSlm'phsltI] simplicity,
We should note here that the articulatory level of analysis suggests the IAI1'ncetJ(a)r(a)li] unnaturally, fmkampceU'blhti] incompatibility, ['Amn'tehd3i­
existence of universals, that is categories applicable for all languages, while '1)JI<lti] unintelligibility.
the functional level of analysis suggests treating each language separately, So far we have described some of the aspects of syllable structure of
because as A. Gimson points out a similar sound sequence can be defined English. The other aspect is syllable division.
differently in different languages.
The definition of the syllable from the functional point ofview makes it 2.3. Syllable Division (Phonotactics)
possible to single out the following features of the syllable:
a) the syllable is a chain of phonemes of varying length; The linguistic importance ofsyllable division in different languages is in
b) the syllable is constructed on the basis of contrast of its constituents 11 nding typology of syllables and syllable structure of meaningful units of a
(which is usually of vowel consonant type); Ilinguage, i. e. morphemes and words. It is the syllable division that deter­
c) the nucleus of the syllable is a vowel, the presence of consonants is mines the syllable structure of the language, its syllable typology.
optional; there are no languages in which vowels are not used as syllable Syllabic structure of a language is patterned like its phonemic structure,
nuclei, however there are languages in which this function can be performed which means that the sounds ofa language can be grouped into syllables ac­
consonants; cording to certain rules. The part of phonetics that deals with this aspect of
d) the distribution of consonants in syllable structure follows the rules n language is called pbonotactics. Phonotactic possibilities of a language
which are specific for a particular language. determine the rules of syllable division.
2.4. Functional Aspect ofthe 55
Chapter II. Syllabic Structure of English Words
54
2.4. Functional Aspect of the Syllable
As the phoneticians point out in the English language the problem of
syllable division exists only in the case of intervocalic consonants and con­ Now we shall consider two very important functions ofthe syllable.
sonant clusters like in the words ['sIb] city, [a'gri:] agree, ['ekstra] extra and The first is the constitutive function. It lies in the ability ofthe syllable to
others. In such cases the point of syllable division is not easily found. Let us be part of a word or a word itself. Syllables form language units of greater
consider the first case. Theoretically two variants are possible: magnitude, that is words, morphemes and utterances. In this respect two
a) the point of the syllable division is after the intervocalic consonant; things should be emphasized. First, the syllable is the unit within which the
b) the point of the syllable division is inside the consonant. relations between the distinctive features of the phonemes and their acous­
In both cases the first syllable remains closed according to the phonetic
tic correlates are revealed. Second, within a syllable (or a sequence ofsyl­
rules ofthe English language because the short vowel should remain checked.

labIes) prosodic characteristics of speech are realized which form the stress
The results of instrumental analysis show that the point of syllable division

pattern of a word and the rhythmic and intonation structure of an utter­


in words like ['plh] pity, ['tupIk] topic, ['me3a] measure, [,bubI] Bobby is inside

ance. In sum, the syllable is a specific minimal structure of both segmental


the intervocalic consonant. This conclusion is of great importance for Rus­

and suprasegmental features.


sian learners of English. They should keep in mind that in the Russian lan­

The other function of the syllable is its distinctive function. The syllable is
guage the stressed syllable in the structure (C) VCV (C) is always open, like

in y-xo, Mfl-ma, 0-6y6b, while in English this kind of syllable is always


characterized by its ability to differentiate words and word-forms. To illustrate
closed if the syllable vowel is short and checked. So it is necessary to make
this a set ofminimal pairs should be found so that qualitative and/or quantita­
tive peculiarities of certain allophones should indicate the beginning or the
transition from a vowel to a consonant very close.
Another type of intervocalic consonant clusters is the VCCV(C) type end ofthe syllable.
like in words [a'gri:] agree, [a'brApt] abrupt and so on. The syllabic boundar­ So far only one minimal pair has been found in English to illustrate the
ies in these words can be determined with the help ofphonological criteria. word distinctive function in the syllable, i. e. [naI-'trelt] nitrate - [nalt-'relt]
In the above mentioned examples the words should be divided into syllables night-rate. The distinction here lies in:
in the following way: [a-'gri:] [a-'brApt] because such combinations ofconso­ a) the degree of aspiration of [t] sound which is greater in the first mem­
nants as [gr] and [brl are permissible initial clusters for the English lan­ ber of opposition than in the second;
guage. On the other hand there are clusters that can never occur in the word b) allophonic difference of [r], in the first member of opposition it is
initial position and consequently should be broken by syllable boundary like slightly devoiced under the influence of initial [t];
in the following cases [~d-'malal admire, [ab-'hJ:] abhor. c) length of the diphthong [al], in the second member of the opposition
There are more complicated cases when the number of intervocalic it is shorter because the syllable is closed by a voiceless plosive
consonants is three or more like in the word ['ekstra] extra and we have to So the syllable division changes the allophonic contents of the word be­
state the possible points of syllable division. cause the realization ofthe phoneme in different syllable positions is different.
The analogical distinction between word combinations can be illustrat­
a) ['ek-str~] - back street
ed by many more cases:
b) ['eks-tr~] - six trees

c) ['ekst-r~] - mixed ray


an aim - a name
In such cases it is the native speaker's intuition that could be relied on.
mice kill - my skill
The subconscious feeling of a new pronunciation effort makes him divide
an ice house - a nice house
the words ofsuch types into [,ek-stral. This natural way ofdivision is fixed in
peace talks - pea stalks
plate rack - play track
the pronunciation dictionary.
In compounds word like ['t3ustrcek] toast-rack it is the morphological Sometimes the difference in syllabic structure might differentiate the
criterion that counts because the boundaries of the syllable should corre­ semantic structure of an utterance:
spond to morpheme boundaries.
56 Chapter II. Syllabic Structure of English Words Chapter III
I saw her eyes. - I saw her rise.
I saw the meat. - I saw them eat. WORD STRESS
Summarizing we might say that on the functional level of description
the syllable could be considered as the smallest pronounceable unit with
potential linguistic importance. That is why it reveals its functional value 3.1. Definition. The Nature of Stress
occasi onally. 3.2. English Word Stress. Production and Per­
By way ofconclusion we could enumerate the following peculiarities of ception
the syllabic structure of English which are relevant for learners of English:
3.3. Degrees ofWord Stress
1) syllabic boundary is inside intervocalic consonant preceded by a short
3.4. Placement of Word Stress
checked vowel; 3.5. Tendencies in the Placement of Word
2) the sonorants [1], [m], [n] are syllabic, ifthey are preceded by noise
Stress
consonants: little, blossom, sudden;
3) the typical and most fundamental syllable structure is of (C)CVC­ 3.6. Functions of Word Stress
type.
Russian learners of English should be aware of the regularities govern­
ing the structure of monosyllabic and polysyllabic words. Wrong syllable
division on the articulatory level may lead to inadequate perception of
phrases and consequently to misunderstanding.

3.1. Definition. The Nature of Stress

Summary The sequence of syllables in the word is not pronounced identically:


some syllables are more prominent than the others. They are called
The sy][able is the sma][est pronounceable unit capable offorming mor­ stressed syllables. So stress is a greater degree of prominence of a syllable
phemes, words and phrases. As a meaningful language unit it has two aspects: or syllables as compared to the other syllables of the word. A particular
syllable formation and syllable division which form a dialectical unity. II combination of varying prominence ofsyUables in a word forms its stress
The syllable is a complicated phenomenon which can be viewed on four I)attern.
levels: acoustic, articulatory, auditory and functional. There exist numerous The effect of prominence of the stressed syllable is achieved by a num­
theories of the syllable. Some of them consider the syllable to be a purely ber of phonetic parameters such as pitch, loudness, length, vowel quality
articulatory unit without any functional value. The majority oflinguists re­ or their combination. As a result there appears a contrast between stressed
gard the syllable as the smallest pronounceable unit which can perform and unstressed syllables.
some linguistic function. There is another term widely used in phonetic literature to describe
In English syllable formation is based on the phonological opposition this phenomenon - accent. The term "accent" generally refers to the
vowel - consonant. Four types of syllables are distinguished: open, closed, pitch component of syllable prominence. Stress is a more general term
covered and uncovered. I han accent because it includes both pitch and other components ofsyl­
The syllable division determines the syllable structure of the language, lable prominence.
its syllable typology. Phonotactic possibilities of a language determine the It should be mentioned that the word "accent" can also be used when
rules of syllable division. I he syllable is perceived as accented due to the pitch prominence and the
The syllable performs two functions: constitutive and distinctive. word is viewed as an utterance or part of an utterance. Even when we pro­
Chapter III. \VOrd Stress 3.2. English \VOrd Stress. Production and Perception 59
58

nounce just one word there is a certain pitch change typical of a spoken 3.2. English Word Stress. Production and Perception
sentence. This phenomenon will be considered in the section of this book
devoted to intonation. As regards the English word there is no agreement among linguists about the
The nature of word stress can be studied from the point of view of pro­ role of particular acoustic parameters in creating the effect of syllable promi­
duction and perception. The production of stressed syllables requires more nence. In other words, they have not arrived at the conclusion yet as to which of
muscular energy. Greater muscular effort and muscular activity produce .1 them contributes to a greater extent to our perception of a syllable as a stressed
higher subglottal pressure and an increase in the amount of air expelled one. The English linguists D. Crystal (1969) and A. Gimson (1981) agree that
from the lungs. On the acoustic level this extra articulatory activity leads English word stress is a complex phenomenon, marked by the variations in force,
to the increase of intensity, duration and fundamental frequency of the pitch, quantity and quality. Different scholars rank these parameters in different
stressed syllable. On the perception level it corresponds to the increase of ways, however each description of English word stress includes loudness, pitch,
loudness, length and pitch. length and quality. Let us give a brief overview ofeach of these parameters.
When we hear a word we often perceive the stressed syllable as louder than
Table 1 unstressed ones. It is the result ofgreater muscular effort which forces the stream
Production and Perception ofthe Stressed Syllables ofair between the vocal cords which vibrate more vigourously. It creates the ef­
fect of greater loudness. However it is impossible to increase the loudness only
Production and Perception Stressed syllable
without changing other characteristics ofthe syllable.
Production level
Greater muscular effort The syllable is perceived as prominent ifthere is a change ofpitch on it. The
Acoustic level Increase intensity, duration, fundamental fre-
acoustic correlate of pitch is the frequency ofthe vibrations of the vocal cords.
quency "Ifall syllables are said with low pitch except for one said with high pitch, then
Perception level Increase ofioudness, the high-pitched syllable will be heard as stressed and others as unstressed"
(Roach, 2001). The placement of pitch change marks the seat of the stress. It
be noted that it is not the direction of pitch change that matters here,
The balance of these components may be different in different lan­
what counts is the movement itself. The fIrSt syllable in the word 'import will be
guages. There are two main types of word stress in the languages of the
perceived as stressed both when pronounced with the falling or the rising tone
world: dynamic and tonic (musical). The dynamic stress is achieved by
(.import, )mport). The shift of stress to the second syllable (import) will be ac­
greater force with which the syllable is prononuced. Greater intensity
companied with a pitch movement on the second syllable.
and duration of the stressed syllable which contains a vowel of full ar­
The length of syllable contributes to the effect of prominence. A greater
ticulation contribute to the effect of prominence. European languages
amount of energy in the production of stressed syllable leads to the increase of
such as English, German, French, Russian, have dynamic word stress.
its length as compared to the unstressed syllables.
Musical stress is observed in Chinese, Japanese, Vietnamese and other
The quality of vowels also plays a certain role in creating the effect ofstress.
languages. This type of stress is the result of the change of pitch in the
A syllable tends to be perceived as prominent ifit contains a vowel which is dif­
stressed syllable. ferent in quality from the vowels in other syllables. \bwels in unstressed syllables
Figure 8 are affected by quantitative and qualitative reduction and vowels in stressed syl­
lables are not. It creates a contrast which increases the prominence of
Types ofWord Stress
stressed syllable.
word stress To sum up, it is generally acknowledged that English word stress is a com­
plex phenomenon formed by interdependent components: loudness,
length and vowel quality. As regards the ranking ofthe components they are not
tonic (musical) equally important, but they generally work in combination.
3.4. Placement ofWord Stress 61
60 Chapter III. Word Stress

3.4. Placement of Word Stress


3.3. Degrees of Word Stress
According to its placement in a word stress can be fixed and free. In lan­
The syllables in a word are characterized by different degrees of prorni­
guages with a fIXed stress the position of the word stress is restricted to a
nence. Objectively, there are as many degrees of stress in a word as there are
particular syllable in a multisyllabic word. For example, in French word
syllables. A. Gimson, for example, shows the following distribution of the
stress is normally fixed on the last syllable ofthe word, in Finnish and Czech
degrees of stress in the word examination (Gimson, 1981). However, it is
it falls on the first syllable, in Polish on the last but one syllable.
important to distinguish the degrees of stress, which are linguistically rele­
There is linguistic data that in 94% of 306 languages with fixed word
vant. stress the stress falls on final, penultimate (last but one) and initial syllable.
In English they generally distinguish three degrees (levels) of stress: pri­
This placement of word stress indicates the word boundaries and thus per­
mary (strong, main, principal), secondary (half-strong, half-stressed) and
forms the identificatory (demarkative) function (J. Laver, 1995; T. Shevchen­
weak (unstressed). In the word hdmtndti6n the primary stress is the stron­
ko,2006).
gest (marked 1), the secondary stress is second strongest (marked 2), all the
In languages with a free stress its location is not confined to a specific po­
other syllables (3, 4,5) are weak. So, all the other degrees ofstress are termed
sition in the word. In one word it may fall on the first syllable, in another on
weak. the second syllable, in the third word - on the last syllable and so on. To be
American phoneticians (B. Bloch, G. Trager, H. Gleason) distinguish
more exact, stress can be placed on any syllable of the word. The number of
four contrastive degrees of word stress: primary, secondary, tertiary and
languages with free word stress is relatively small: English, Russian, Italian,
weak. Tertiary stress does not show much difference from secondary stress,
Greek, Spanish and some others (English - 'appetite, be'ginning, ba'lloon),
but it has a different placement in a word. It is generally associated with
Russian - o3epo, nOi?oiJa, MOJlOKO).
American English, where it marks the last but one syllable in the words
In English (as well as in Russian) the word stress is not only free, but it
with suffixes -ary, -ory, -ony (,revo'lutio,nary, 'dictio,nary, 'cere,mony). It is
is also shifting, which means that it can change its position in different forms
argued that the secondary stress precedes the primary stress and the ter­
of the word and its derivatives: 'contrast - con'trast, 'music - mu'sician, 'hab­
tiary stress follows it. For example, in the verbs with the suffIxes -ate, -ize,
it - ha'bitual, 60iJbl - 60iJa - 600flH0i1, ttyoHafl - ttyiJHafl.
_y tertiary stress can be observed (,demonst,rate, 'orga,nize, 'simplify). Some
Table 2
British linguists share this point of view, because there is a tendency to use
'JYpes of Word Stress according to its Placement
a tertiary stress in a post-tonic syllable in the words with an unreduced
vowel in the last syllable in British English (,black,board, 'demonst,rate, 're­ 'JYpe of Word Stress Position of Stress
a,lize). fIxed restricted to a particular syllable
A. Gimson, for example, distinguishes four degrees of stress, which
free is not restricted, stress can be placed on any syllable
are realized mainly by the change of pitch, to be more exact, he describes
four degrees of word accent: primary accent, marked by the last major
Admittedly it is difficult to predict the location of English word stress.
pitch change in a word; secondary accent, marked by a non-final pitch
Some linguists suppose that the speaker has to memorize the stress pattern
change in a word; a minor prominence produced by the occurrence of a
of each word as it is learned. However, there exist some generalizations con­
full vowel, but containing no pitch change; a non-prominent syllable con­
cerning the placement of word stress which the native speaker of English
taining no pitch change and one of the vowels [I, U, a] (Gimson, 1981).
makes unconsciously and stores in the mind (Ph. Carr, 1999; P. Roach,
According to J. C. Wells "tertiary stress is the location of a potential rhyth­
2001). To define the position ofword stress in each individual word it is nec­
mic beat either after the primary stress or between the secondary and the
essary to take into account a number of factors:
primary" (Wells, 1993).
- phonological structure of the syllables;
However, in terms of teaching English as a foreign language the Brit­
- the number of syllables in the word;
ish conception of three degrees of word stress is more acceptable.
Chapt.er HI. \\brd Stress 3.4. Placement. of\\brd Stress 63
62

_ morphological factor (whether the word is simple, complex or com­ Besides complex words we should also consider compound words. Com­
pound); pounds contain more than one root or more than one word, but they function
_ the part of speech the word belongs to (noun, verb, adjective, etc.). as one word. Compounds can be spelled in different ways: as one word (suit­
The phonological structure of the syllable, or synable weight is related to ., case), with a hyphen (good-tempered), or as two words (work day). According
the status of a particular syllable in terms of the degree of sonority. The to P. Roach "the most familiar type ofcompound is the one which combines
sounds that possess a greater degree of sonority contribute to the greater two nouns, and normally has the stress on the first element" (P. Roach, 200 I).
prominence (weight) ofsyllable. A syllable is considered to be strong (heavy) This stress pattern can be observed in the following compounds: 'sunrise, 'type­
when it contains a long vowel or a diphthong or a short vowel followed by writer, 'greenhouse, 'bedroom. However, quite a number of compounds take
two consonants. The influence ofthis factor can be illustrated by the follow­ stress on the second element: bad-'tempered, second-'class, North-'West, i/l­
ing example: in English verbs the stress falls on the last syllable ifit is strong 'treat. Another typical stress pattern is: secondary stress on the first element +
and on the last but one syllable if the last one is weak (light), e. g. a'rrive primary stress on the second element (t::lear-'cut).
de'velop. British phoneticians (Ph. Carr, P. Roach) suggest a rule that sums up the
The number of syllables in a word influences the number ofstresses and
most typical tendencies in the placement of word stress in compounds:
to a certain extent the position of stress. There are stress patterns typical of
stress goes on the first element if it is a noun ('wine glass, 'suitcase) and on
two-syllable words, three-syllable words and so on. In multi-syllable words
the second element if the first is adjectival in meaning, in other words if it
there appears secondary stress.
performs the function of an attribute (,heavy-'handed, .five-'finger, .first­
Another factor to be considered is the morphological factor, in particu­ 'rate). It should also be mentioned that compounds can have only one pri­
lar, whether the word is simple, complex or compound. In complex words mary stress (J. C. Wells), if there are more than one stressed syllables sec­
the placement of stress depends on the type of suffIx. Suffixes are divided ondary stress might be used. "The model with two primary stresses was
into those which do not affect the stress placement in the stem ( stress­ replaced by a more productive model secondary + primary in the 60s-70s of
neutral ), those which influence stress in the stem (stress-fIXing) and those the 20 th century" (T. Shevchenko, 2006)
which carry stress themselves (stress attracting). We should mention here that the location of word stress in connected
In the word with a stress-neutral SuffIX the stress remains on the same syl­ speech is influenced by the position of the word in the sentence. You can
lable in the stem. This group includes such suffIxes as -aI, -able, -en, -jul, compare the placement ofstress in the following pairs:
-lng, -ish, -less, -ness, -ly, -ment, -ous and others (re'fuse re'fusal, 'comfort­ pagefourteen - fourteen pages
'comfortable, a'maze - a'mazing, 'happy - 'happiness, agree a'greement). Westminster Westminster Abbey
Stress fixing suffIXes determine the placement of stress on a particular She is bad-tempered. - She is a bad-tempered girl.
syllable ofthe stem. SuffIXes -ion, -ic, -tty, -ial, -ive attract stress to the syl­
lable that precedes them, 1. e. the last syllable ofthe stem ('peifect - perfec­ This variability ofword stress is accounted for by the influence ofspeech
tion, 'proverb - pro'verbial, 'curious cun"osity). Verbal suffix -ate in words of rhythm, which tends towards a regular alteration between stressed and un­
more than two syllables fixes the stress on the third syllable from the end stressed syllables.
('operate). The fourth factor which should be considered is the dependence ofword
Stress attracting suffIXes include such suffIXes as -ade, -eer, -ee, -esque, stress on the grammatical category the word belongs to. The influence of
-ette (cru'sade, mounta'neer, refu'gee, ,ciga'rette, pictu'resque). this factor can be illustrated by the pairs of words, in which adjective and
In some cases this factor is to be considered together with another one ­ noun are contrasted to verbs: 'insult - in'suit, 'record re'cord, 'peifect - per­
the number ofsyllables in a word. For example, the verbal suffix -ate is stress 'fect, 'present - pre'sent.
attracting in the words containing two syllables (migrate), but in words con­ So to predict the assignment ofword stress it is necessary to identifY and
taining more than two syllables it is stress-fIXing; it fixes the stress on the consider the factors that independently or in combination determine the
third syllable from the end (com'municate). placement of stress. Philip Carr, for example, views these factors in the fol­
Chapter III. Word Stress 3.6. Functions of Word Stress 65
64

lowing order: the syntactic category of the word (nouns behave differently ute - distribute, 'aristocrat a'ristocrat. The stress on the initial syllable is
from verbs and adjectives), syllable weight, morhological structure (the ad­ caused by the diachronical recessive tendency or the stress on the second
dition of suffixes can have consequences for the way that a word is stressed) syllable under the influence of rhythmical tendency.
The third tendency is called retentive. A derivative retains the stress of
(Ph. Carr, 1999). the original (parent) word, e. g. 'similar - as'similate, recom'mend - ,recom­
The study of the factors listed above can give some guidance as regards
the placement of word stress in Modern English. However, it is generally men'dation. Sometimes in the derivative the primary stress of the original
acknowledged that the accentual pattern of English words is liable to insta­ word turns into secondary stress, e. g. 'demonstrate - ,demonstration.
due to the inner typological proccesses that are a result of the histori­ Figure 9
development of the language. These processes are described as tenden­ Tendencies in the Placement of Word Stress
cies in the placement of word stress.

3.5. Tendencies in the Placement of Word Stress recessive tendency retentive tendency

They generally distinguish three tendencies which account for the

ations of stress patterns in English: recessive, rhythmical and retentive ten­


dencies.
Recessive tendency is the tendency to stress the beginning of the word 3.6. Fnnctions of Word Stress
typical of Germanic languages.
In Germaic languages, where short one or two-syllable words predomi­ Word stress performs the following functions:
nated, the stress originally fell on the initial syllable or the second syllable, the Word stress organizes the syllables into a word. It creates a particular
root syllable in words with prefixes. Unrestricted recessive tendency is ob­ pattern of relationships among syllables, making some syllables more prom­
served in the native English words with no prefix (,mother, 'daughter, 'brother, inent than others and thus shapes the word as a whole. Thus word stress
'swallow, 'carry) and in assimilated French borrowings Creason, 'colour). Re­ performs the constitutive function.
stricted recessive tendency marks English words with prefixes, some ofwhich Word stress makes it possible for the listener to identify a succesion of
no longer exist as such (fore'see, with'draw, be'gin, a'part,/otget). syllables with a definite recurrent stress pattern as a word. In other words, it
A great number of words of Anglo-Saxon origin are monosyllabic and helps us to recognise the word in the chain ofspeech. This function is called
disyllabic words with the stress on the first or the second syllable. They al­ identificatory ( recognitive).
ternated in the chain of speech with unstressed form words, which created Word stress is capable of differentiating the meaning of words or their
the peculiar rhythm of English speech. The rhythmical tendency reflects the forms, thus performing its distinctive function. Primary stress placement can
rhythm of alternating stressed and unstressed syllables. This tendency distinguish:
caused the appearance of the secondary stress in the multi syllable French - the grammatical category (morphological class) of the word in the
borrowings, e. g. revo'lution, ,organi~~ation, as,simi'lation, etc. It also explains oppositions 'import - im'port, 'insult - in'sult, 'conduct - con'duct, in which
the placement of primary stress on the third syllable from the end in three- I
the stress falls on the first syllable in nouns and on the last syllable in verbs;
four-syllable words, e. g. 'cinema, 'situate, atticulate, significant. The the meaning of the word, e. g. 'billow be'low;
LvlTelation of recessive and rhythmical tendencies can be traced in bor­ - compound nouns from free word combinations, e. g. 'blackboard
rowed three-syllable words, e. g. 'family, 'library, 'faculty, 'possible. In most 'black 'board, 'greenhouse - 'green 'house. In compound nouns primary stress
cases, however, these two tendencies contradict each other, which leads to is placed on the first element, while in word combinations adjective + noun
the existence of such accentual variants as 'hospitable - hos'pitable, 'distrib&, there is primary stress on both elements.
66 Chapter Ill. Word Stress Summary
67
In Russian word stress also performs the distinctive function, differen­ According to its placement stress can be fixed or free. Both in English
tiating lexical meaning of words (l.Iye)ftaR - Ltye)JltiFt, 3CtM01C - 3aMo,,) and and in Russian word stress is not only free, but it is also shifting, it can
grammatical forms of words (3UMbl 3UMbl, 6eabl- 6eabl). change its position in different forms ofthe word.
Discussing the functional aspect of word stress we should mention that To define the position ofword stress in an individual word it is helful to
the accentual structure of compound words is very closely connected with consider the following factors: the phonological structure of a syllable (syl­
their semantic value. Some authors describe this phenomenon as a semantic lable weight), the number of syllables in the word, the morphological factor
tendency in the placement of word stress: the stress is generally assigned to (if the word simple, complex or compound) and the grammatical category
the elements which have a greater semantic, distinctive weight. the word belongs to.
By way of illustration we shall look at the placement of stress in com- " They generally distinguish three tendencies that account for the varia­
pound words. In the examples given above ('blackboard - 'black 'board) and tions of stress patterns in English: recessive, rhythmical and retentive ten­
in such pairs as (gentleman - gentle 'man) the placement ofstress on the first dencies.
morpheme in compound nouns signifies that the words "have a single Word stress can perform the following functions: consitutive (it orga­
meaning, not made up from the meanings of sub-parts" (Ph. Carr, 1999), nizes the syllables into a word), identificatory, or recognitive (it helps the
while two equal stresses on both parts of word combinations show that each listener to recognise the word in the chain of speech) and distinctive (it can
element has its own meaning. distinguish grammatical forms and meaning of words).
Basically, the stressed element has a greater semantic value than the un­ The correct selection of a syllable or syllables to stress in an English
stressed one. We can also say that the stress falls on the element which conveys word causes a lot of difficulties to Russian learners. So in teaching pronun­
new important information. For example, in such compound nouns as 'din­ ciation special attention should be given to the aspects which present diffi­
ing-room, 'bathroom, 'bell boy, 'ballet dancer the first element is more signifi­ culties due to the instability of English stress structure, on the one hand,
cant, more informative, which is expressed by the placement of stress on the and the differences in English and Russian word stress:
first morpheme. Here are some more examles: 'powder-like, 'oval-shaped. stress in multi-syllable words, containing secondary stress;
- stress in complex words containing suffixes;
stress in compound words;
Summary - word-class pairs with shifting stress ('insult - in'sult).

\\brd stress is a greater degree ofprominence ofa syllable or syllables as


compared to the other syllables of a word.
The stressed syllables are pronunced with more muscular energy than the
unstressed ones. On the acoustic level stressed syllables are characterized by
increased intensity, duration and fundamental frequency, which correspond
to increased loudness, length and pitch on the perception level.
There are two types of word stress: dynamic and musical (tonic).
English word stress is a complex phenomenon formed by interdepen­
dent components: loudness, pitch, length and vowel quality.
The syllables in a word have different degrees ofprominence. In English
they generally distinguish three linguistically relevant degrees of stress: pri­
mary, secondary and weak. Some scholars also include tertiary stress, but
the first classification is more acceptable for teaching English as a foreign
language.
4.1. Definition of Intonation 69
Chapter IV
What is the role intonation plays in the language? Intonation is indis­
INTONATION pensable in communication, because it is instrumental in conveying mean­
ing. No sentence can exist without a particular intonation. No meaning can
be expressed without it.
Intonation can be described on the acoustic level (in terms of its acous­
4.1. Definition of Intonation
lie characteristics), on the perception level (in terms of the characteristics
4.2. Components of Intonation perceived by human ear) and on the linguistic level (in terms of meanings
expressed by intonation). We would like to start with the description of in­
4.3. Intonation Pattern as the Basic Unit of
lonation on the perception and acoustic levels and then pass over to its lin­
Intonation guistic function.
4.4. Notation What is intonation? It is quite impossible to describe intonation in a
word or two. Sometimes the ups and downs of pitch and loudness are com­
4.5. Functions of Intonation pared to the waves of the ocean. "The surface of the ocean responds to the
4.5.1. Communicative function as the basic forces that act upon it in movements resembling the ups and downs of the
function of intonation human voice" (Bolinger, 1972).
4.5.2. Distinctive function There exist various approaches to the description of intonation and dif­
4.5.3. Organising function ferent definitions of this phenomenon. This polyphony of views can be ac­
4.5.4. Intonation in discourse counted for by the complex nature of intonation itself.
4.5.5. Pragmatic function According to most Russian linguists on the perception level intonation
4.5.6. Rhetorical function is defined as a complex, a whole, formed by significant variations of pitch,
loudness and tempo (the rate ofspeech and pausation) closely related. Some
4.6. Rhythm
definitions also include timbre (voice quality), which is sometimes regarded
4.6.1. Speech rhythm. Definition. Typology
as the fourth component of intonation. In our opinion timbre should not be
4.6.2. Rhythmic group as the basic unit of
part of the definition, because it has not been sufficiently described yet.
rhythm Neither its material form nor its linguistic function has been objectively in­
4.6.3. Rhythm in different types of discourse
vestigated. Though speech timbre can definitely convey certain shades of
4.6.4. Functions of rhythm
attitudinal or emotional meaning there is no good reason to consider it
alongside with the three basic components of intonation, 1. e. pitch, loud­
ness and tempo.
In the British and American tradition intonation is restricted to the
4. 1. Definition of Intonation pitch (tone) changes only. Intonation is identified with pitch movements
In this chapter we shall focus on intonation, the topic ofparticular theo­ (or melody), because pitch has the greatest linguistic value. This approach
retical and practical interest. It is the sphere of suprasegmental phonetics. to intonation goes back to the definitions given by the prominent British
The flow ofspeech does not consist only ofsegmental units (speech sounds), phoneticians in the first halfof the XX century. "Intonation may be defmed
there are also other phonetiC means that characterize a sequence of speech as the variations which take place in the pitch of the voice in connected
speech" (D. Jones, 1976). This point of view is shared by contemporary
sounds. They are called suprasegmental or prosodic means.
Intonation is a language universal. There are no languages which are linguists. "Intonation involves the occurrence of recurring pitch patterns,
spoken as a monotone, i. e. without any change of prosodic parameters. But each of which is used with a set of relatively consistent meanings, either on
single words or on groups ofwords ofvarying length" (A. Cruttenden, 1986).
intonation functions in various languages in different ways.
70 IV. Intonation 4.2. Components of Intonation 71

"Intonation is the use of pitch variation to convey meaning" (P. Roach, \ariations in voice pitch occur within the normal range of the human
200l). voice, 1. e. within the interval between its upper and lower limits. Three pitch
It can be seen that Russian scholars have a broader view of intonation. levels (keys, registers) are generally distinguished: high. medium and low.
We are convinced that it is impossible to restrict intonation to pitch param­
eters only because generally all the three prosodic paramelers function as a high

whole. Giving priority to the pitch variations, we will adopt a broader defi­ - - - - - - - - - - medium

nition, which will allow us to consider the semantic value of all the three
components ofintonation. - - - - - - - - - - low
There is another term "prosody", which is used in slIprasegmental pho­ The pitch range is the interval between two pitch levels. When we speak
alongside with the term "intonation". The term "prosody" refers to about the pitch range of the whole intonation unit we mean the interval be­
the variations of the same parameters (pitch, loud ness, li.lIlll)(») and is wide­ tween the highest-pitched and the lowest-pitched syllables. Pitch ranges
ly used in linguistic literature. maybe normal, wide and narrow.
It should be noted that British phoneticians view prosody us a broader
notion than intonation and single out such prosodic fcnturcs as pitch, loud­
Iwide

ness, tempo and rhythm (D. Crystal, 1. Wells and olh(]l's). According to
1. Wells "the prosodic (or suprasegmental) charactcrisliGs of speech are
Inormal

those of pitch, loudness and speed (or tempo, or speech rate). They com­
Inarrow

bine together to make up the rhythm of speech... " (J. Wells, 2006).
Loudness is described as normal, increased (forte) or low (piano).

We are not going to dwell here on differentiation ofllle !lotions "intona­


Tempo includes rate of speech and pausation.

tion" and "prosody". \\e shall use the term "intonation" because it is gen­
The rate of speech can be normal, slow and fast. Generally, the parts

erally used in teaching practice, however reference willlliso bll Inade to pro­
sodic features. of the utterance which are particularly important are pronounced at a
slower rate, while in less important parts the rate of speech tends to be
faster.
Any stretch of speech can be split into smaller segments by means of
4.2. Components of Intonation pauses. A pause is a complete stop of phonation. Pauses are classified ac­
cording to their length, their position in the utterance (final - non-final)
As we have already said, the components of in tonal ion, or supraseg..:
mental features that form intonation can be viewed 011 I.Iw IWollstic level. and their function.
rn teaching English intonation it is sufficient to distinguish the follow­
Each of them has its own acoustic correlate and can Ill' Ol*lctively mea­
sured. The acoustic correlate ofpitch is fundamental frC(llI(lllcy ofthe vibra­ ing types ofpauses:
tions of the vocal cords; loudness correlates with intensity. (l'll II)() correlates l. Short pauses which may be used to separate intonation groups within a
with time (duration) during which a speech unit lasts. phrase.
2. Longer pauses which normally manifest the end of the phrase.
Acoustic analysis ofintonation is used in experinlclllnlll'Hcnrch. Here
intonation will be described in terms of perception , which is 1II000e accept­ 3. Very long pauses which are used to separate bigger phonetic units (pho­
able for the aims ofteaching. nopassages).
It is generally acknowledged that each component Functionally, there may be distinguished syntactic, emphatic and hesi­
guistically relevant and can be described as a system. tation pauses.
system oftones (fall, rise, fall-rise and so on), pitch levols Syntactic pauses separate phonopassages, phrases, intonation groups.
be high, medium and low, and pitch ranges (wide, medilllll illlilllurrow). Emphatic pauses serve to make some parts of the utterance especially
prominent.
72 Chapter IV. Intonation 4.3. Intonation Pattern as the Basic Unit ofIntonation 73

She is the most I charming girll've ever seen. I A phrase (a sentence actualized in oral speech) may contain one or sev­
The subject ofthis talk is I intonation. I eral intonation groups. The number of intonation groups depends on the
Hesitation pauses are mainly used in spontaneous speech to gain some length of the phrase and the semantic importance given to various parts of
time to think over what to say next. They may be silent (unfilled) or fIlled. the phrase:
She is rather a Igood student. This v bed 'was 'not 'slept .in. II - I This bed I was v not 'slept .in. I
Where does she live? - Um, notfar from here. I An additional nuclear tone on this contrasts "this bed" to "other beds".
It is clear that pauses can perfonn various functions. Besides the seg­ Here is another example:
mentation ofthe speech continuum, pauses contribute to the temporal and I
-+ Last tSummer v we went to 'stay with my 'sister in ,London.
rhythmical organization of speech. I
-+ Last tSummer v we went to 'stay with my tSister I in ,London. I
As it was already said pauses are easily perceived when there is a stop of
phonation. However there are cases when we perceive a pause when there is The phrase above can be pronounced with either two or three intona­
no stop ofphonation. It happens because a stop ofphonation is not an tion groups.
factor indicating an intonation group boundary. Thus, the impression ofthe The intonation pattern may include the following components: the nu­
boundary between speech segments may be created by perceivable pitch clear tone (nucleus), the head, the pre-head and the taiL Now we shall dwell
change, either stepping down or stepping up, depending on the direction of in more detail on each of these components.
the nuclear tone movement. Figure 10
All the three components ofintonation, i. e. pitch, loudness and tempo Intonation pattern and its components
form the intonation pattern, the basic unit of intonation. intonation pattern

4.3. Intonation Pattern as the Basic Unit of Intonation


Eachsyllable in the speech chain has a special pitch colouring. Some of pre-head nuclear tone
the syllables are characterized by significant moves of tone up and down.
Each syllable bears a definite amount ofloudness. Pitch movements are Not all the stressed syllables in the intonation group are of equal prom­
separably connected with variations of loudness. Together with the tempo inence. To highlight the most important word the speaker accents it, adding
of speech they fonn an intonation pattern which is the basic unit ofinton a­ pitch prominence. One of the syllables has greater prominence than the
tion. others. It is the nucleus or the focal point (focus). The nucleus may be de­
An intonation pattern has one nuclear tone (nucleus) and may contain scribed as a syllable which is marked by a significant change in pitch direc­
other stressed or unstressed syllables preceding or following the nuclear tion, i. e. where the pitch goes distinctly up or down. The nuclear tone is
tone. The boundaries of an intonation pattern may be marked by stops of most important part ofthe intonation pattern. The intonation pattern can­
phonation, i. e. temporal pauses. not exist without it. At the same time the intonation pattern may consist of
Intonation patterns serve to actualize syntagms in oral speech. A syn­ one syllable, which will be
tagm is a group of words which is semantically and syntactically complete. The nuclear tones are generally grouped into simple (Low Fall, Low Rise
In phonetics actualized syntagms are called intonation groups (tone groups). and others), complex (Fall-Rise, Rise-Fall) and compound (Rise + Fall +
Each intonation group may consist ofone or more potential syntagms. For Rise). According to R. Kingdon, the most important nuclear tones in Eng­
example, the sentence I think he is coming soon has two potential syntagms: which should be included in the course of pronunciation for foreign
I think and he is coming soon. In oral speech it is nonnally actualized as one learners, are: Low Fall, High Fall, Low Rise, High Rise, Fall-Rise (R. King­
intonation group. don, 1958). D. Crystal postulates "a major division of nuclear tones into two
T

74 Chapter rv. Intonation 4.3. Intonation Pattern as the Basic Unit of Intonation 75

types: falling, the fInal direction of pitch movement being downward in each
'" Those who 'work in the voffices I "'ought to take 'plenty of ,e:xerci~e.
case, and rising, the fmal direction of pitch movement being upward. The
"'When ['come Vback I we will ~talk about it a,gain.
category oflevel tone retains an ambiguous status in respect of this division"
(D. Crystal, 1969). According to J. \\ells "the most basic distinction among The Fall-Rise is also chosen by speakers when they want to refer to
English nuclear tones is that between falling and non-falling" (J. Wells, 2006). something already mentioned in the conversation or to the information
A. Cruttenden claims that there are three main factors which are the basis for shared by the speakers and the hearers.
the classifIcation of nuclear tones in English: the initial movement Let's go to the cinema on Friday. - I'm going to the v cinema I on ,Thurs­
nucleus: fall or rise or level; the beginning point ofthis initial movement: high day.
or low; a second change of pitch direction following the nucleus, which pro­ This coat is beautiful. - It's vbeautiful, I but ~very eX,pensive.
duces such tones as rise-fall and fall-rise. He distinguishes seven nuclear
tones: Low Fall, High Fall, Low Rise, High Rise, Fall-Rise, Rise-Fall and 1. Wells calls this nuclear tone Fall- Rise", because it
Mid-Level (A. Cruttenden, 1986). is used when the speaker says one thing implies something further
The meanings of nuclear tones are difficult to specify in general terms. (J. Wells, 2006):
Roughly speaking, the falling tone of any level and range expresses "fInali­ When can we meet? - We could meet on v Sunday (but not on Monday, but
ty", "completeness", "certainty", "independence". it might not suit you).
Where is John? - He ~hasnJt ,come yet.
The falling-rising tone, as its name suggests, consists of a fall in pitch
What~., the time? - It's "'nearly'jive o',clock.
followed by a rise. If the nucleus is the last syllable of the intonation group
A rising tone of any level and range expresses "incompleteness", "de­ the fall and rise both take place on one syllable the nuclear syllable. Other­
pendence", "uncertainty". This tone conveys the impression that the con­ wise the rise occurs in the remainder ofthe tone unit:
versation is not fInished and something else is to follow. The rising tone is Do you agree with him? - v Yes.
used when the speaker wants to encourage further conversation. What can I do to mend matters? You could ap,ologize to fier.
I think I'll go now. - ~Are you ,ready?
Level tone is used in two main contexts. According to P. Roach, in short
Michael is coming to London. - '>I.Is he 'coming ;I'oon?
utterances it conveys a feeling of saying something routine, uninteresting
and boring (P. Roach, 2001). It is frequently used at intonation group
The rising tone is frequently used in polite requests, invitations, greet­
boundaries conveying non-finality.
ings, farewells and other strategies of social interaction.
I'm afraid I can't manage it. - In vview o/'all the >circumstances I "'whv not
What shall I do now ? ~Do go pn.

'try a,gain ?
Couldyoujoin us? ~Not ,now.

'>I. First we'll dis'cuss >one othing IVthen will 'pass on to a,nother.

The Fall-Rise is often used in English and conveys a variety of mean­ Mid- Level tone is particularly common in spontaneous speech func­
ings. When used at the end of the phrase it expresses reservation, that is it tionally replacing Low Rise.
asserts something and at the same time suggests that there is something else We should also mention such nuclear tones as Rise-Fall and Rise-Fall­
to be said, e. g.
Rise. They add refmement to speech, but it is generally recommended to
Do you like pop-music? ~ v Sometimes.
introduce these tones at the advanced level, when foreign learners have al­
It's very interesting. v Yes,
ready mastered the basics of English intonation.
We have given a very general overview of the basic nuclear tones. Each
The Fall-Rise can also be used in non-final intonation groups. It ex­ of these tones can express other meanings in particular contexts. Some of
presses non-finality and indicates that another point is to follow: them will be considered in the section "Functions of Intonation".
76 4.3. Intonation Pattern as the Basic Unit of Intonation 77
Chapter IV. Intonation

Returning to the structure of the intonation pattern, we should say ~"Why are you 'making such a ,mess of it?
that the tone ofa nucleus determines the pitch ofthe rest ofthe intonation
pattern following it, which is called the tail. Thus after a falling tone the
rest of the intonation pattern is at a low pitch. After a rising tone the rest
of the intonation pattern is in an upward pitch direction.
,
... ..
The examples show that different types of pre-nuclear patterns do not
,No, oMary. - ,Well, OMary. affect the grammatical meaning of the sentence but they can convey
The nucleus and the tail form what is called terminal tone. speaker's attitude.
Summing up, we may say that minimally an intonation pattern con­
The two other sections of the intonation pattern are the head and the
pre~head. They form the pre-nuclear part of the intonation pattern. The
sists of one syllable, which is its nucleus, Maximally it may include three
head contains the syllables beginning with the first stressed syllable up to, other elements: the head, the pre-head and the tail.
The meaning of the intonation group is the combination ofthe mean­
not including, the nucleus. The pre-head consists of unstressed or
half-stressed syllables preceding the head. The head, the pre-head and the conveyed by the terminal, pre-nuclear part, pitch level and pitch
tail are optional elements of the intonation pattern. range.
Obviously the elements of the intonation pattern can be combined in
We were "'wondering ifyou could 'come to 'dinner to,morrow. various ways and express a variety of meanings, Compare the meanings of
the following utterances:
The pre-nuclear part can take a variety of pitch patterns. Such varia­
tions do not usually affect the grammatical meaning of the utterance, Not at ,all. (calm, reserved)
but they often convey attitudinal or stylistic meanings. The character of ~ Not at ,all. (weighty, considered)
pitch movements in the pre-nuclear part is often quite complex and ~ Not at ,all. (encouraging, friendly)
heterogeneous. Generally three common types of pre-nucleus are dis­ ~ Not at 'all. (questioning)
tinguished: a descending type in which the pitch gradually descends to ~ Not at 'all. (surprised)
the nucleus; an ascending type in which the syllables form an ascending ~ Not at \fall. (protesting)
sequence and a level type when all the syllables are more or less on
same level: The number of possible combinations is more than a hundred, but not
all of them are of equal importance. So in teaching it is necessary to select
Descending type Ascending type Level type a limited number ofintonation patterns which are frequently used in Eng­

-, lish discourse and which have a particular communicative value.


In these sections we have considered in a very general way the compo­
nents of intonation. It follows from this overview that all of them are
Compare the types ofhead in the following phrases: closely interconnected in the processes of speech production and speech
perception. We must point out here that the changes in pitch, loudness
"'"Why are you 'making such a 'mess of it? and tempo are not accidental variations. The rules governing these chang
es are highly organized. Irrespective of the individual prosodic character­
"'". istics that can be traced in each speaker, these changes tend to become
standardized, so that all speakers of the language use them in similar ways
.."."Why are you 'making such a 'mess of it? under similar circumstances. These characteristics of intonation struc­

... .'
,
"­ .... tures may be called intonation units which form the prosodic system of
English.
78 Chapter IV. Intonation 4.5. Functions ofIntonation 79

4.4. Notation symbols, i. e. by a downward and an upward arrow or a slantwise stress mark.
More than that. Pitch movements in the pre-nuclear part can be indicated
What is the best suitable way of representing intonation in the text? too. Thirdly, it is very convenient for marking intonation in texts.
There are a variety ofmethods for recording intonation patterns in writ­ One ofthe disadvantages ofthis method is that there is no general agree­
ing and we can look at the advantages and disadvantages of some of the ment about the number of terminal tones and pre-nuclear patterns English
commoner ones. The first three methods reflect variations in pitch only: intonation system requires in order to provide an adequate description. So
1. The method introduced by Ch. Fries (1965) involves drawing a line the simplest (D. Jones) recognizes only two tones, a fall and a rise easy to
around the sentence to show relative pitch heights: distinguish, but not sufficient for phonetic analysis. We should definitely
He's gone to the /o/Vice. give preference to a more complex system, such as J. D. O'Connor and
G. F. Arnold's, which has no fewer than ten different nuclear tones. It is
2. According to the second method the syllables are written at different heights quite sufficient for teaching pronunciation even to advanced learners. The
across the page. The method is particularly favoured by D. Bolinger (1972): most detailed indication of the pre-nuclear part of the intonation pattern is
I absolutely deny it. introduced in the textbook «npaI<'I'Jl'IeCKM Q:>oHeTHKa aHf.JIHHCKoro H3blKa»
(CoKOJIOBa M. A. I1 )]p., 2001) in whichJ. D. O'Connor and G. F. Arnold's
Bolinger's book has the cover title: system underwent further modification. All the relevant pitch changes in
a the pre-nuclear part are indicated by arrows placed before the first stressed
ton t syllable instead of an ordinary stress-mark, cf. :
i That 'isn't as 'simple as it 'sounds. That -+isn't as 'simple as it 'sounds.
In o
That "'isn't as 'simple as it 'sounds.
n
That isn't as 'simple as it 'sounds.
}I

This method is quite inconvenient as its application wants a special


We believe it is clear from the above that this system deserves recogni­
model of print.
tion not only because it reflects all relevant variations of the two prosodic
3. According to third, "levels" method, a number of discrete levels of
components of information but also because it serves a powerful visual aid
pitch are recognized, and the utterance is marked accordingly. This method
for teaching pronunciation.
was favoured by some American linguists such as K. L. Pike (1958) and others
Our further point will be the description of the functional aspect ofinto­
who recognized four levels ofpitch: low, normal, high and extra-high, num­
nation in different textual discourse units. To establish the linguistic relevance
bering them from 1-4. Since most linguists who have adopted this method
ofprosodic features it is necessary to look for contrasts or oppositions, which
have favoured low-to-high numbering, we shall use this in our example:
can show their linguistic significance. In the next section we are going to look
2 3 1 at each component of intonation, or, in other words, each prosodic feature,
He's gone to the office.
pitch, loudness and tempo and the way they function in speech.
This notation corresponds to the pattern of the example illustrating the
first method.
4. The fourth method is favoured by most of the British phoneticians 4. 5. Functions of Intonation
such as D. Jones, R. Kingdon, J. O'Connor and G. Arnold, M. Halliday,
D. Crystal and others, as well as by Russian phoneticians who have success­ 4.5.1. Communicative function as the basic function ofintonation
developed it. This method has a number of advantages. Firstly, not
onlyvarlations ofpitch but also stressed syllables are marked. Secondly, dis­ Our further point will be the description of intonation on the func­
tinct modifications of pitch in the nuclear syllable are indicated by special tionallevel. Intonation is functional, i. e. it is used in a language for par­
80 Chapter IV, Intonation 4.5. Functions of Intonation 81

ticular purposes and is never merely decorative. Within any language into­ 4.5.2. Distinctive function
nation is systemic: different speakers tend to use the same patterns for the
same purposes. If the speaker uses wrong intonation he can easily slip in To demonstrate how intonation performs the distinctive function we must
accent or can even be misunderstood. view it on the phonological level. Phonology has a special branch, intonology,
Intonation is a powerful means of human communication. It has a whose domain is larger units ofconnected speech: intonation groups, phrases
great value for expressing ideas and emotions and contributes to mutual and even phonetic passages. The same as in the case ofsegmental phonemes
understanding between people. One of the aims of communication is the the phonological approach to intonation involves the analysis based on a sys­
exchange of information between people. The meaning of an English ut­ tem ofoppositions. By oppositions here we mean minimal pairs of phrases of
terance, i. e. the information it conveys to a listener, derives not only from identical grammar structure and lexical composition, in which the difference
the grammatical structure, the lexical composition and the sound pattern. in meaning is expressed by intonation only.
It also derives from variations of intonation, in other words the prosodic The descriptions of intonation show that phonological facts of intonation
parameters ofthe utterance. system are much more open to discussion than in the field of segmental pho­
Because of the complex nature of intonation and its high linguistic nology. Descriptions differ according to the kind ofmeaning attributed to into­
potential, there is no agreement among phoneticians about the functional nation and the significance attached to different parts ofthe tone-unit (intona­
aspect of intonation. The functions of intonation have been very differ­ tion pattern). J. O'Connor and G. Arnold claim that the major function of
ently described and classified. Thus, T. M. Nikolaeva (2004) names three intonation is to express the speaker's attitude to the situation he is placed in,
functions: the functions of delimitation, integration and semantic func­ and they attach these meanings not to the pre-head, head and nucleus sepa­
tion. N. V. Cheremisina (1982) singles out the following functions: com­ rately, but to each often "tone-unit types" as they combine with each offour
municative, distinctive (or phonological), culminative (accentual), inte­ sentence types: statement, question, command and exclamation.
grative, delimitating, expressive, aesthetic. According to A. Gimson M. Halliday supposes that English intonation contrasts are grammatical.
(1981) intonation has two basic functions: accentual and non-accentual. He argues that there is a neutral or unmarked tone choice and explains all
The classification of P. Roach (2001) includes attitudinal, accentual, other choices as meaningful by contrast. Thus, if one takes the statement "I
grammatical and discourse functions. D. Crystal (1995) distinguishes the don't know", the suggested meanings are: Low Fall - neutral, Low Rise ­
following functions: emotional, grammatical, informational, textual, psy­ non-committal, High Fall - contradictory, Fall-Rise with reservation,
chological, indexical. J. C. Wells (2006) recognizes such functions as at­ Rise-Fall with commitment. Unlike J. O'Connor and G. Arnold, M. Hal­
titudinal, grammatical, focusing (accentual, informational), discourse liday attributes separate significance to the pre-nuclear choices, again taking
(cohesive), psychological, indexicaL one choice as neutral and the others as meaningful by contrast.
It can be argued that since intonation is viewed as a powerful means of D. Crystal presents an approach based on the view that "any explanation
communication, its basic function is communicative. It follows from this of intonational meaning cannot be arrived at by seeing the issues solely in
that it is impossible to divorce any function of intonation from that of their grammatical or attitudinal terms. " He ignores the significance of pre­
communication. No matter how many functions are named, all of them head and head choices and deals only with terminal tones.
may be regarded as the realization of the communicative function. There are other similar approaches which possess one feature in com­
The communicative function of intonation embraces all its numerous mon: little attention is paid to the phonological significance ofpitch level and
uses, which can be grouped in the following way: the use of intonation to pitch range.
distinguish meanings and the use of intonation to organize, or structure In this book intonation is viewed on the phonological level as a complex sys­
the oral text. The first can be described as the distinctive (phonological) tem of all the prosodic parameters and a powerful means ofcommunication.
function and the second - as the organizing function of intonation. In this What kind of meanings can be distinguished by intonation? Intonation
chapter we shall also give an overview of pragmatic, rhetorical and social is capable of distinguishing the syntactic type of sentence, the attitudinal
functions of intonation. meaning and the actual meaning of the utterance.
82 Chapter IV .Intonation 4.5. Functions ofIntonation 83

a) Intonation is used to distinguish the syntactic, or communicative type difficulties to foreign learners of English. Special attention should be given
of sentence, in other words, it can indicate whether the utterance is a state­ to using the appropriate intonation to convey attitudes.
ment, a question, a command or an exclamation. c) Intonation can differentiate the actual meaning of the sentence. The
-7Isn't it ,wondeiful? (general question)
change of meaning is achieved by the opposition of nuclear tones.
-7Isn't it 'wondeiful! (exclamation)
Have you read the book? Not ,once.
"'Will you 'stop Jalking?(command)
When pronounced with Low Fall it means that the speaker has not read
"'Will you 'stop ialking? (request)
the book.
It can be seen from these examples that it is the change of the nuclear Have you read the book? Not Vance.
tone that leads to the change of the syntactic type of sentence.
When pronounced with Fall-Rise it means that the book has been read
The following sentence can be pronounced in different ways. several times.
It's a lovely day. Similarly, the meaning is changed in the following phrases:

When pronounced with the Low Fall this sentence is a statement, I "'don't 'want you to 'read ,anything. (You should avoid reading.)
pronounced with the High Fall it becomes an exclamation, when it is said ["'don't 'want you to 'read vanything. (You should be more particular
with the Low Rise it is a question. about your choice of reading matter.)
The change ofmeaning can also be the result ofthe shift ofterminal tone.
An important role of intonation is to express attitudes of the speakers.
It can convey a wide range ofattitudes, thus performing the attitudinal func­ He's a -7 French ,teacher. (He comes from France.)
tion. When people speak they can sound angry or happy, pleased or surprised, He's a ,French teacher. (He teaches French.)
interested or indifferent, and so on. The same sentence can be pronounced in Figure 11
different ways and thus express a variety ofattitudinal meanings. Distinctive Function of Intonation
When can you do it? ,Now. (detached, reserved)

When did you finish? - 'Now. (involved)


intonation can differentiate
You are to do it right now. - v Now? (astonished)

How omuch did you JJay for it? (cool, reserved)

How omuch did you 'pay for it? (lively, interested)

syntactic types of sentences attitudinal meaning


It is not only the nuclear tone but the pre-nuclear pattern as well
head, the pre-head) that can differentiate the attitudinal meaning.
As you have seen from the examples given above it is the opposition ofter­
It was -7quite a 'good .lecture. (matter-of-fact, uninvolved)

minal tones that can differentiate all kinds of meaning: the syntactic type of
It was v quite a 'good 'lecture. (impressed)

sentences, attitudinal meaning and the actual meaning of the sentence. The
It should be noted that the changes in pitch are usually accompanied by number of terminal tones which indicates the number ofintonation groups in
changes in the rate of utterance , loudness and voice quality. an utterance is also relevant for the meaning. Different phrasing, or subdivision
When we speak about attitudes and emotions we mean both the attitude ofsentence into intonation groups, may result in differences in meaning.
to what is said, to the listener, to the situation and the emotional state ofthe For example, the sentence My sister, who lives in the South has just ar­
speaker. So it is a fairly complex phenomenon which may present particular rived may be interpreted in two different ways.
--~

84 Chapter rv. Intonation 4.5. Functions ofintonation 85

My sister I who lives in the South I has just arrived. I It means "My only There are cases when groups of intonation patterns may be treated as
sister who happens to live in the South ... " synonyms. It happens when fine shades of meaning in different situations
My sister who lives in the South Ihas just arrived. I It means "That one of modify the basic meaning they express. The basic meaning of any falling
my sisters, who lives in the South ... " tone in statements is finality. Low Fall and High Fall both expressing final­
ity have their own particular semantic shades. Pronounced with Low Fall a
In a written text this difference in meaning is sometimes marked by
statement will sound detached and reserved. High Fall together with final­
punctuation, while in oral speech it is expressed by intonation.
ity may express concern, involvement:
As regards the other components of the intonation pattern (the pre­
head, the head) they differentiate only attitudinal meaning. Being pro­ Where's my copy? ,Peter took it for you.
nounced with the high pre-head, "Hello" sounds more friendly than when or: 'Peter took it for you.
pronounced with the low pre-head:
Isn't it a lovely view? DeJightful.
Hel,lo! - -Hel,lo! or: De'lightful.
More commonly, however, different kinds of pre-heads, the same as
pitch ranges and levels fulfil their distinctive function not alone but in com­
bination with other prosodic constituents. 4.5.3. Organizing function
-Very 'clever, .isn't he? As it was already mentioned, intonation serves to structure the text. On
-That's quite 'interesting. the one hand, it delimitates the text into smaller units, on the other hand, it
ties together smaller units into bigger ones. These two processes take place
Finishing the overview ofthe distinctive function of intonation we must
simultaneously.
look at the relationship of intonation, syntactic structure and lexical com­
When we speak about delimitation (or segmentation) we mean that into­
position in an utterance. Generally intonation is in balance with other lan­
nation can divide the text into phonopassages (or dialogue blocks), phrases,
guage means. For example questions express a certain amount of interest,
intonation groups. In spoken English the smallest piece of information is
which is normally conveyed both by their syntactical structure and inter­
associated with an intonation group, that is, a unit ofintonation containing
rogative intonation. However, there are cases when intonation is in contra­
a nuclear tone. There is no eXact match between punctuation in writing and
diction with the syntactic structure and lexical composition of the utter­
intonation groups in speech. Segmentation ofspeech into intonation groups
ance, neutralizing and compensating them. For example, a statement may
depends on a number of factors, such as the length of syntactical units, the
sound questioning: He was late a,gain?
intention of the speaker to give emphasis to particular parts ofthe message,
There are cases when intonation neutralizes or compensates the lexical
the degree of formality ofdiscourse, the tempo of speech and others. A sin­
content ofthe utterance as it happens, for instance, in the command -;.Phone
gle phrase may contain just one intonation group, but when its length goes
him at .once, please, when the meaning of the word please is neutralized by
beyond a certain point, it is difficult not to split it into two or more chunks
intonation.
of information.
-;.How 'very ,nice. Due to intonation this utterance sounds negative in
contrast to the syntactic structure and the wording. The man told us we could park it here. I
Lack of balance between intonation and word content, or intonation The man told us I we could park it at the railway station. II
and grammatical structure of the utterance may serve to create special The man told us I we could park the car I in front ofthe pub I in the street
speech effects, irony, for example: over there. II
Very >clever, Jsn't he? As we have already mentioned, the number of intonation groups in an
-;.1hat's 'quite .interesting. utterance may affect its meaning. Compare:
86 Chapter IV. Intonation 4.5. Functions ofIntonation 87

"'Jane 'put the 'book on the .table. Notice that the decision as to whether some information is retrievable or
Jane I "'put the 'book on the .table. II not has to be made by the speaker on the basis ofwhat he thinks the addressee
can take for granted from the situation, etc. The speaker must, in framing the
SO, together with nuclear tones pauses perform the function of de­ utterance, make many assumptions, and he does this rapidly and to a large
limitation, dividing the text into smaller units. degree unconsciously. He then arranges his intonation groups and assigns nu­
Intonation also serves to combine smaller units and organize them clear tones accordingly. But in any particular situation, the speaker's assump­
into bigger ones: intonation groups - phrases phonopassages texts. tions run the risk ofbeing wrong: what he takes to be retrievable information
Intonation shows what things belong more closely together than may not in fact be retrievable for the addressee. In this case there is a break­
others. It also shows what is subordinate to what. Thus, intonation con­ down of communication, and the listener will probably seek clarification:
nects textual units with other textual units and contributes to the cohe­
sion of the spoken text, thus performing the integrative function. Admit­ I'd like a new DVD.
tedly, integration and delimitation are not formal things, these processes The position ofthe nuclear tone on the last notional word ofthe intona­
are the realization of the information content of the text. tion group (end-focus position) is viewed as the basic, neutral, unmarked.
Now, we will consider in more detail the role of intonation in con­ In actual speech the rheme and the nuclear tone may be placed differ­
veying the information content of an utterance. Intonation highlights the ently. Such position of the nuclear tone is called marked.
most important information in an utterance, which helps to distinguish
which information is new and which information is known to the lis­ Did Jack go to Paris? - No, Mark went to Paris.
tener. The nuclear tone is shifted when the speaker wants to give focus to a
The information in a message is divided into new (the rheme) and particular part ofthe intonation group, usually to contrast it with something
given (the theme). Given information is something that, as the speaker already mentioned, or understood in the context. In the marked position
assumes, the listener already knows. New information is something that the nuclear tone is sometimes called contrastive focus or logical sentence
the speaker thinks the listener does not know. Here is an example: stress. Compare the placement of the nuclear tone in the following dia­
What did John say to you? He was talking to ,Mary I not to ,me. logues:
In the response "he was talking" is given information. It should be Where was he born? - He was born in London.
mentioned that "given information" can be retrieved not only from the Did your brother study in London? - No, he was born in London.
verbal context (something that was already mentioned or referred to) or
the situation. It is also associated with the knowledge that the speaker and Any part ofspeech (even pronouns, prepositions, auxiliaries) may carry
the listener share. For example, if both participants know that several new information and be in the focus position.
people are expected to come, the phrase "The doctor has come" will be It's not vour book, it's ours.
pronounced with the nuclear tone on the word "doctor", though no verbal The book is not on the table, it's in the tab/e.
context preceded it. So the context here is to be taken in a very broad
sense. Whlch syllable ofthe word is stressed, ifit has more than one syllable, is
New information is the most important part of the message. It is con­ determined by ordinary conventions of word stress: to'morrow, 'picture,
centrated in the information centre, which may consist of a single word or ,demon'stration.
be spread over a number ofwords. The nuclear tone marks the nucleus of An important conclusion to be made here is that intonation plays a very
the information centre, 1. e. the information focus. important role in structuring the discourse: it organizes words into a mean­
ingful phrase, it ties phrases together within a text, showing in the process
Jack went to Paris. II where divisions come, which things are more important, what is subordi­
I'd like a new DVD. II nate to what and so on. In other words, intonation signals how phrases go
88 Chapter IV Intonation 4.5. Functions oflntonation 89

together in a spoken discourse. At the same time intonation reflects the in­ In recent years there has been an increasing interest of linguists in
fluence of the context, both verbal and extralinguistic, on the speech real­ analyzing "the way sentences work in sequence to produce coherent
ization. stretches oflanguage" (D. Crystal, 2007). Linguistic disciplines that deal
Let us consider the sentence "It was an unusually rainy day". At the be­ with these problems are called text linguistics and discourse analysis.
ginning ofa story the last three words would be particularly important, they Some scholars apply the term "discourse" to spoken language, while the
form the semantic centre with the nucleus on the word "day". The first term "text" is used to describe the structure of written language. However,
three words playa minor part. The listener would get a pretty clear picture since our primary concern is the functional aspect of intonation in oral
ofthe story's setting if the first three words were not heard because of some speech we are not going to specify the particular meaning of the terms and
outside noise and the last three were heard clearly. If the last three words look at the prosodic organization of oral discourse, or text.
which form the semantic centre were lost there would be virtually no infor­ The study of oral discourse, i. e. structures extending beyond the sen­
mation gained at all. tence, demonstrates that intonation is ofcentral importance for the mean­
The same sentences may be said in response to the question "What sort ing and interpretation of spoken language.
ofday was it?" In this case the word "day" in the reply would lose some ofits Probably one of the most important functions of intonation is tying
force because the person who asks the question already possesses the neces­ the major parts together within the phrase and tying phrases together
sary information. In this situation there are only two important words within the text showing in the process what things belong more closely
"unusually rainy" and they would be sufficient as a complete answer to together than others, where the divisions come, what is subordinate to
the question. The nucleus will be on the word "rainy". In reply to the ques­ what, and whether one is telling, asking, commanding or exclaiming. In
tion "Did it rain yesterday?" the single word "unusually" would bear the other words, in the previous sections we considered aspects of meaning in
major part of the information, would be, in this sense, more important than isolation, but now we shall focus on how meanings may be put together
all the others and consequently would be the nucleus of the intonation pat­ and presented in an oral discourse.
tern. It is demonstrated in recent phonetic investigations that intonation
The word "was" has little value in the previous examples, but ifthe sen­ plays a very important role in the semantic organization of textual units.
tence were said as a contradiction in the reply to "It wasn't a rainy day yes­ Here is a brief account of how intonation contributes to structuring an
terday, was it?", then "was" would be the most important word of all and oral monologue.
indeed, the reply might simply be ((It was" ,omitting the following words as . Firstly, intonation is a cue to boundaries between discourse segments.
no longer worth saying. In this phrase the word "was" is the nucleus of the This boundary is perceived due to the pitch parameters and pauses. Gener­
semantic centre. ally the beginning of a topical textual unit is marked by a high onset, in other
These variations of intonation achieved by shifting the position of the words, the pitch range in the initial syntagm is comparatively wide and it
terminal tone show how the opposition ofthe distribution ofterminal tones gradually becomes narrower at the end of the textual unit. There is a marked
fulfils integrating function. Together with delimitation, integration can be change ofpitch at the boundaries between textual units which may be accom­
viewed as the basic aspect of discourse. panied by a rather long pause and sometimes a change of loudness.
In the next section we will view the functions ofintonation with refer­ In the example presented below (an extract from a lecture) the begin­
ence to discourse. nings of textual units are in bold print:
The origin ofthis lecture I may perhaps be I a purely British problem. II And
4.5.4. Intonation in discourse I hope this will emerge perhaps I in the course ofdiscussion afterwards, II but it is
concerned with the role ofliterature, I reading and discussing literature I in the
We have so far confined our description ofthe functional aspect ofinto­ teachingofforeign languages. III
nation to phrases, now we want to look at the functions of intonation with The first point I that J need to make I is that modem languages I the study of
reference to discourse. foreign languages in England Iwas established at university level relatively late. III
90 Chapter IV. Intonation 4.5. Functions of Intonation 91

Besides marking boundaries intonation is an important means of bind­ In this dialogue phrase A is the context for phrase B, while B is a re­
ing textual units together thus creating cohesion of spoken discourse. It is sponse to A and thus is relevant to A as a response to a special question.
generally acknowledged that sentences in a text do not occur at random, Relevance is the phenomenon that enables humans to converse. It is clear
there is a mutual dependence ofelements that form the text. Intonation acts that if we take phrase B in isolation its meaning will be obscure. So rele­
as an indicator of semantic relationships of both between and inside textual vance exists only ifthere is a context.
units. By the placement of the nuclear tone, or accentuation, it is shown If we take an utterance like "John" in isolation, we cannot say much
which lexical items carry new information. So the elements of the text about its structure or meaning. But as soon as we make it relevant to a con­
which convey important information are marked by prosody, while others text, both the structure and meaning become clear.
remain unmarked which contributes to expressing and developing the in­
formation content oftextual units and whole texts. Who is in the house? John.
Intonation can show which phonopassages are more important in terms We can that it is an elliptical sentence and the meaning is"John is in
of information they convey. Their prosodic organization is generally char­ the house"'. The same phrase will have a different structure and meaning in
acterized by higher key, wider pitch range, greater loudness as compared to a different context:
the phonopassages which convey additional or less important information.
The following extract from a talk given by a student of Cambridge is an il­ Who did they see? John.
lustration of how intonation actualizes the information content of textual The full form of response is "They saw John", a phrase in which the
units: the lexical items carrying new information are in bold print, phrases sequence "John" is now an object. So the two utterances "John" appear
conveying low-key information are underlined. identical in isolation, but different contexts allow us to see their differ­
Television Iis really still Ithe dominantform ofentertainment in England. II ence.
And you know I there are 5 channels: I RRC 1, 12, IlTV, IChannel 4 I and re­ Analysing the role of intonation in discourse we must consider both
cently Channel 5 has started out. II Rut in my opinion 1the RRC I is still Iyou the verbal context and the speech situation. The example given above il­
know I the best channell to put it plainly'. II It:~ very well respected abroad and lustrates the connection between the information structure, L e. the
at home. II It gives very good news coverage I it produces great dramas I orher placement of the nucleus, with the verbal context and the speech situa-
types oLprogrammes. III
So the study of intonation in discourse is based on detailed analysis
A" regards the prosodic organization ofdialogues, or conversational in­ of the context, both the immediate verbal context and broader context
teraction there are two aspects to be taken into account here: the role of of speech interaction.
intonation in organizing dialogues and the role ofprosody in structuring the When we view intonation in relation to discourse special attention is
interaction itself (turn taking, interruptions and so on). given to the relevant factors which determine the choice of intonation in
We shall start with the organization of connections between phrases, particular context. Generally two areas are considered in this respect: the
with considering how one idea leads on to another. Intonation is one of use ofintonation to focus the attention ofthe listener on the most impor­
the means that fulfils this connection, performing the integrating func­ tant elements of the message and the use of intonation to regulate the
tion. conversational behaviour (A. Cruttenden, P. Roach, A. Wichmann).
Obviously, in a spoken discourse a phrase does not exist in isolation, it As regards the first area, it was already mentioned that in speech in­
is closely connected to other phrases, especially to the one preceding it. teraction the placement of the nuclear tone depends on the verbal con­
So a phrase exists in a certain verbal context and is relevant to this context. text, i. e. on what has already been said. Compare the position of the
Let's look at the following dialogue: nuclear tone in the following short conversations.
A: Where is John? How does the story start?
B: He is in the house. "It was an unusually dark night... "
92 Chapter IV. Intonation 4.5. Functions oflntonation 93

In this case the position of the nuclear tone is unmarked, it is the so­ leaving problem to go in the tail, can be interpreted as implying that life is a
called broad focus, and the whole phrase is perceived as new, important succession ofproblems. " (J. C. Wells, 2006). The use ofFall-Rise expresses
information. Here are some examples of the marked position ofthe nuclear reference to the knowledge shared by the speaker and the listener.
tone (narrow focus): Another aspect of how intonation functions in discourse is the ability of
What sort ofnight was it?
intonation to regulate conversational behavior. Various prosodic signals can
It was an unusually dark night.
be used to show that one person has finished speaking, that he wants to con­
tinue speaking, that he is expecting an answer or that he is encouraging an­
Nights are usually dark here.

other person to continue the conversation. It can be observed in turn-taking


It was an unusuallY dark night.

in a dialogue.
The night was not very dark yesterday.

It was an unusually dark night.


Hello, Anna. It's ages since I've seen you. How are you doing?

- Not so bad. Busy as usual with exams. And you?

Focusing the attention of the listener on a particular part ofthe message - Oh, still at the same place, you know, but enjoying it.

can also be achieved by creating contrast between less important (low-key)


information and more important (high-key) information. The High Fall at the end of the first utterance and the High Rise at the
end ofthe second utterance signal that it is the turn ofthe other participant
Last time I as I am sure YOU remember I we discussed the functions ofinto­ to speak. The rising tone encourages further conversation.
nation. Similarly, intonation can show what particular type ofanswer is expect­
Thank you very much for coming I nice of you to give us your time. ed from the listener. Compare two short dialogues:
prosodic characteristics of the intonation group containing low­ - Who do you think will help?
key information as compared to the other intonation groups in the utter­ - ,Jack will, ,won't he?
ance are lower pitch level, narrower pitch range, increased tempo, lower - Well, I hope so.
loudness. As a result these intonation groups are perceived as subordinate,
parenthetical or just less important. The Low Rise in the tag question indicates that the speaker expects an
Intonation can also be used as a reference to the information shared by answer and wants his partner to express either agreement or disagreement.
the participants ofdiscourse. Speakers use falling tones in the parts of the ut­ - The food is very expensive here.
terance which they think is unknown to the listener. They use the Fall-Rise - It .is, .Isn't it?
when they refer to the information shared by themselves and the listeners.
The Low Fall in the question is a signal that no answer is expected
- What shall we give July?

and the agreement of the partner is assumed.


- As she likes vreading! we could -"give her a ,book.

In the analysis of spoken discourse special attention is given to the in­


- How about going out on Friday?
teractional me(lning of language means. To explain how language units
I've got a -"meeting on v Friday.
function in social context scholars rely on the pragmatics of discourse.
In natural speech both the placement and the choice of nuclear tone
reflect numerous implications of social interaction. 1. C. Wells gives an in­ 4.5.5. Pragmatic function
teresting example ofthe situation which he witnessed himself. "A taxi-driv­
er was picking up two passengers who had a lot ofluggage. The driver loaded According to contemporary ideas in pragmatics speech communica­
most ofthe cases into the boot ofthe car, but could not find room for the last tion is effective when people follow special rules which govern speech
one. So he finally placed it on the back seat. One passenger said to the oth­ interaction and which are recognized by all members of the language
. er: "We've solved that problem". The placement of the nucleus on that, community. "Pragmatics studies the factors which govern our choice of
,

94 Chapter IV. Intonation 4.5. Functions ofIntonation 95

language means in social interaction and the effects of our choice on Intonation can contribute to greater expressiveness of an utterance. Slid­
others" (D. Crystal, 1995). ing Head and High Fall in combination with wide pitch range, increased
There are two important aspects in this definition. First, our choice loudness and slow tempo make the following utterances very expressive:
of language means, and prosodic means in particular, is determined by This ""car is ""terribly ex'pensive.
the rules of speech behaviour in a particular speech situation. For ex­ The ""food was 'terrible, I am oSorry to oSay.
ample, if a person asks a question he or she expects to get an answer, or Into""nation 'plays a very im'portant 'role in 'human communi,cation.
if a person wants to engage you in a small talk and makes a comment
about the weather, you are supposed to react in a similar way. Second, by Emphatic pauses are often used to make the sentence more expressive.
choosing different language means, including the prosodic means, we I was so exhausted I that at the end ofthe holiday I I needed I a holiday. II
can produce different kinds of influence on the listeners. The pragmatic function of intonation is manifested in all types of dis­
As regards the pragmatic function of intonation, it consists in the use course, but it is particularly vivid in the discourse which is specifically
of intonation with a specific purpose. In other words, when used in dis­ designed to implement pragmatic goals. Admittedly, it is especially
course, intonation serves to actualize the speaker's pragmatic aim. vant in literary texts and in public speaking. In this context the pragmatic
the choice of the nuclear tone can be the result of the pragmat­ function is referred to as the rhetorical function of intonation.
ics of discourse, i. e. what the speaker wants to achieve in the course of
speech interaction. Thus, a statement can be used as a request for infor­
mation and then the rising tone will be used instead of the falling tone: 4.5.6. Rhetorical function
You are ,coming? In rhetorical discourse the main goal of the speaker is persuasion. The
You really be,lieve it? public speech is planned, structured and delivered as an oral text aimed at
influencing the intellect, the emotions of the listeners or both. Naturally,
A command which is normally pronounced with a fall will function as a
polite request when said with a rise or a warning when pronounced with a
I when presenting the speech in public the speaker chooses the prosodic
means which will contribute to the implementation of his or her goals and
fall-rise:
objectives and make the speech effective. Here are some examples.
""Come and ,help me. Now Ithe reasonfor thiy was Ithat in the middle ofthe 19" century Iin Britain
....Do be ,careful. Ithere had been a very Iviolent Idebate Iabout thefuture ofeducation.
,Wait for ,me.
The phrase is divided into short intonation groups, emphatic pauses
Here is another example of the pragmatic use of intonation in social are used. The tempo is slow. The pitch range is wide. Peculiar accentua­
speech interaction. In a British university a pasta dish was offered on the tion when every word is stressed, even the preposition in, the use of Slid­
menu at lunch time. It was served as a complete dish (big portion) or with ing Head and High Falls make the utterance sound weighty. The whole
vegetables (smaller portion). The students discovered that if they said "I'll utterance is perceived as very expressive.
have the pasta" with a final fall, they were served a big portion, because the In rhetorical discourse prosodic parameters are frequently radically
caterer presumed that notlling else was to follow. After a pause the students changed, which contributes to the pragmatic effect. When the speaker
added "and chips, carrots and peas, please" so the caterer had to add vege­ wants to convey important information the tempo is slowed down and the
tables to the already full plate. "The pasta fall" is a good illustration ofhow length of pauses increases.
the choice of nuclear tone affects the meaning of tile utterance and how
intonation is used for very practical purposes (A. Wichmann, 2000).
English has never been a syllable-timed language. III Until nowll.
It should be mentioned that the pragmatic use of intonation is also as­ Another technique is the use of repetitions, when prosodic parallelism
sociated with its ability to affect the intellect and emotions of the listener. often accompanies syntactic parallel constructions.
96 Chapter IV. Intonation 4.6. Rhythm 97

I could have given a quick account ofthe history II could have said what it time. It can be observed in the succession ofseasons, heart beating, breath­
was like to be a student here a hundred years ago I I could have told you about ing, in music, dancing and other forms ofart.
the great museums I and libraries Iand college chapels. Speech rhythm is traditionally defined as a regular occurrence ofstressed
syllables in a speech continuum. Speech rhythm is also described in terms
Besides conveying information intonation is used to impress, affect of acceleration and slowing down, of relaxation and intensification, length
the listeners and thus it performs the pragmatic or rhetorical function. and brevity, similar and dissimilar elements. The type ofrhythm depends on
Summing up, we can say that intonation plays a very important role the language. Languages are divided into two groups: syllable-timed, like
in making communication effective. French, Spanish, Italian, Greek and others, and stress-timed, such as Eng­
Discussing the use of intonation in discourse we should mention an­ lish, German, Dutch, Russian and other languages.
other important function, which is referred to as social, or indexical. In syllable-timed languages an approximately equal amount of time is
Intonation is a marker of personal and social identity. According to D. given to each syllable, regardless of it being stressed or unstressed. In other
Crystal, lawyers, preachers, sports commentators, teachers are readily words, "all syllables, whether stressed or unstressed, occur at regular time
identified through their distinctive prosody (D. Crystal, 1995). Intona­ intervals and the time between stressed syllables will be shorter or longer in
tion can be an indicator of the social status of an individual and his or proportion to the number ofunstressed syllables" (P. Roach, 2001). In these
her social role. languages there is practically no reduction of unstressed vowels.
In particular speech situations intonation can express the dominance stress- timed languages stressed syllables tend to occur at relatively
of one of the participants. He might use wider pitch range, slower tem­ equal intervals of time, According to the stress-timed theory time intervals
po, use the rising tone instead of fall-rise as a referring tone and so on. between stressed syllables are approximately the same irrespective of the
You were supposed to have done it by the twenty fourth.
number ofunstressed syllables between them, which is generally described as
- The twenty-tSixth, IOthink.
a tendency to isochrony. In such languages rhythm is based on a larger unit
- The twenty sixth ofMay? Surely not.
than syllable. This rhythmic unit is called the foot or the rhythmic group. The
stressed syllables in the rhythmic group form peaks of prominence.
It is important to note here that discourse can take many forms, deter­ As it was already mentioned, the duration ofrhythmic groups is consid­
mined by the situation in which it takes place, the participants and their ered to be equal. However, this principle which is accepted by most phone­
relationships. Intonation is subject to variation depending on the extralin­ ticians has not been experimentally verified (A Cruttenden, P. Roach, A
guistic situation. These recurrent variations are described in terms ofpho­ Gimson). Despite the insufficiency of acoustic data, the perception of
netic styles. Intonation can perform the stylistic function, which will be stress-timing in English is evident. This effect is particularly noticeable due
described in Chapter V. to the reduction and elision of vowels in unstressed syllables. Also due to the
changes in length, pitch, loudness and vowel quality in the stressed syllables
they are perceived as prominent in contrast to the unstressed syllables,
4.6. Rhythm which creates the abrupt, spiky effect of English rhythm.
Table]
4.6.1. Speech rhythm. Definition. JYpology Rhythm in Different Languages

The description of English intonation and the phonetic aspect of con­ languages rhythm
nected speech is incomplete without some reference to speech rhythm. syllable-timed equal amount oftime is to each syllable, stressed or
Rhythm is viewed as a kind offramework of speech organization. unstressed

In a broad sense rhythm is understood as periodicity in time and space. stress-timed stressed syllables occur at equal intervals oftime and form
The notion of rhythm implies that something occurs at regular intervals of peaks ofprominence in rhythmic groups
98 Chapter IV. Intonation 4.6. Rhythm 99

4.6.2. Rhythmic group as the basic unit of rhythm nization will be very different and may even produce the effect of arhyth­
micality. P. Roach comments on such variations in English speech rhythm
The basic unit of rhythm is the rhythmic group (the foot, the phonetic in the following way: " ... in speaking English we vary in how rhythmically
word), which can be defined as a speech segment containing a stressed syl­ we speak: sometimes we speak very rhythmically (this is typical of some
lable and unstressed syllables attached to it. The stressed syllable is the nu­ styles of public speaking), while at other times we speak arythmically (that
cleus of the rhythmic group. The unstressed syllables preceding the stressed is, without rhythm) - for example, when we are hesitant or nervous. Stress­
syllable with which they are grouped are called proclitics, those following timed rhythm is thus perhaps characteristic of one style of speaking, not of
the stressed syllable are called enclitics. English speech as a whole; one always speaks with some degree of rhythmi­
There are two alternative views among phoneticians concerning the cality, but the degree will vary between a minimum value (arythmical) and
grouping of stressed and unstressed syllables. According to the first point of a maximum (completely stress-timed rhythm)" (P. Roach, 2001). It is true
view the grouping is based on the semantic principle: the unstressed sylla­ to say that any style of speech has some kind of rhythm, but the character
bles tend to be drawn either to the stressed syllable of the same word or to and degree of rhythmicality differ in different styles.
the lexical unit with which they are semantically connected:. Admittedly, maximum rhythmicality is observed in poetry. In verse the
They decided I to go I to the country Ifor the weekend. effect of rhythmicality is created by a hierarchy of rhythmic units. The basic
rhythmic units in metric verse are: the foot, the line, the stanza. The foot is
According to the other point ofview the unstressed syllables tend to join
the preceding stressed syllable. This theory is called enclitic. According to formed by the stressed syllable and the unstressed syllables that precede or
follow it. The line contains one or more intonation groups with an equal
the enclitic principle the same phrase will be divided into rhythmic groups
number offeet in them. On the prosodic level the rhythm in a line is secured
in the following way:
by the similar number of syllables, their temporal similarity, descending
They decided to Igo to the I country/or the I weekend. melody contour, tone and intensity maximum at the beginning, tone and
The enclitic tendency is considered to be more typical of-English, intensity minimum at the end and a final pause. These parameters make the
though experimental data show that the type of division into rhythmic a stable rhythmic unit. The stanza has a fixed number of lines.
groups depends on the tempo and style of speech. The enclitic tendency is Obviously, the effect of poetic rhythm is not created by prosody alone.
observed in rapid colloquial speech, while in careful slow speech the se­ There is a number of devices which contribute to this effect: rhyme, asso­
mantic tendency prevails. . nance (repetition of similar vowels), alliteration (repetition of similar con­
It is generally acknowledged that the rhythmic group is the basic unit of sonants)' repetition, syntactic parallelism and so on.
rhythm. It functions as such in all types of texts. But the description of Earth has not anything to show more fair.
rhythm is not limited to the rhythmic group. According to A. M. Antipova Dull would he be ofsoul who could pass by
(1984), the rhythmic structure of speech continuum is a hierarchy of rhyth­ A sight so touching in its majesty:
mic units of different levels. Rhythmicality created by interrelation of lexi­ This city now doth, like a garment, wear
cal, syntactic and prosodic means, marks every text segment: rhythmic The beauty o/the morning; silent, bare,
groups, intonation groups, phrases and phonopassages. Ships, towers, domes, theatres and temples lie
Open unto the fields, and to the sky,
4.6.3. Rhythm in different types of discourse All bright and glittering in the smokeless air.
(w. Wordsworth)
An important factor which regulates speech rhythm is the style of
speech. Thus, rhythm has a great rhetorical potential in public speaking. Poets control the rhythmical patterns they use, because rhythm is a
Admittedly, it possesses great aesthetic value in literary texts, especially in powerful means of creating poetic images. In the following extracts from
poetry. As far as spontaneous conversation is concerned, its rhythmic orga­ two classical poems this intention of the authors is perfectly clear:
100 Chapter IV Intonation 4.6. Rhythm 101

Those evening bells! Those evening bells! In public speaking marked regularity of rhythm, usually based on the
How many a tale their music tells, repetition of intonation patterns, is often used as a rhetorical device, which
Oflove, and home, and that sweet time is aimed at making the presentation more effective.
When last I heard their soothing chime! J couldl I suppose Ihave given a quick account ofthe history II. I could have
(Th. Moore) said what it was like to be a student here a hundred years ago. II I could have
told you about the famous people who'd come here. II J could have told you
The woods are lovely, dark and deep,
about the great museums, I and libraries, I and college chapelsll, but you could
But I have promises to keep,
get all that out ofguidebooks IIand you'll be seeing most ofthese things anyway I
And miles to go before J sleep,
as you walk about.
And miles to go before J sleep

(R. Frost) Rhythmical organization of spontaneous speech is more complicated,


more varied and flexible, than that of a literary text. It is generally associ­
In prose we can also observe a hierarchy of rhythmic structures. The ated with physiological and cognitive processes in speech production
basic rhythmic unit here is rhythmic group (one stressed syllable with un­ speech perception.
!\tr4~!\!\I~d syllables attached to it). Rhythmic groups blend together into in­ Finishing up this brief overview of the tendencies that characterize the
tonation groups, which form phrases and phonopassages. The similarity rhythm of oral discourse, we should say that in actual speech communica­
of the prosodic organization of these text units creates the effect of regu­ tion rhythmical patterns used by speakers vary considerably. If speakers
larity. Thus in prose an intonation group, a phrase and a phonopassage used the same rhythmical patterns, they would sound monotonous. So
have a number of common features in their prosodic organization: the alongside with regularity of rhythm we can observe all kinds of variations
beginning of the rhythmic unit is characterized by the tone and intensity and irregularities.
maximum and the decrease oftempo; the end ofa rhythmic unitismarked
by a pause, the tone and intensity minimum, descending terminal tones.
4.6.4. Functions of rhythm
So it is prosody that forms the rhythmicality of a prosaic text read aloud.
The following extracts from modern fiction illustrate the rhythmic orga­ Rhythm serves to organize segments of speech: smaller units are or­
nization of prose: ganized into larger ones, larger units include smaller ones. Rhythm
unites text segments into a whole and at the same time divides discourse
The west ofEngland was once remote, Iinaccessible I and inconvenient. II into elements. On the one hand, the stability of rhythm contributes to
Somerset, I Devon, I Cornwall. II Country cousins lived there, I whose uncouth the integration of the text and its parts. On the other hand, the change of
accents Iprovoked ridicule I when they came up to town. II It was picturesque in rhythm marks the boundaries between parts of the text. So rhythm per­
those parts, I but barbarous I and to be avoidedl except for purposes ofabsentee forms the functions of delimitation and integration which form a dialec­
landownership. III tical unity.
(Penelope Lively) Another function of rhythm is aesthetic. Rhythmically organized
Some hours before dawn I Henry Perownel a neurosur.geonl wakes to find speech is easily perceived and produces a certain emotional effect on
himself already in motion, I pushing back the covers from the human beings. It is assumed that the regularity of speech rhythm is in
and then rising to his feet. II It's not clear to him I when exactly he became con­ with biological rhythm. This use of rhythm is of special sig­
harmony
sciousl, nor does it seem relevant. II He's never done such a thing before, I but nificance in poetry.
he isn't alarmedl orevenfaintly surprised, Ifor the movement is easy, and plea­ Rhythm can also make discourse expressive and thus increase its
surable in his limbs, I and his back and legs Ifeel unusually strong. II pragmatic potential. This function of rhythm is of special value in public
(Ian McEwan) speaking. In rhetorical terms rhythmically organized speech is more
102 Chapter Iv. Intonation Summary 103

fective. Admittedly, rhythmical effect in public speaking is achieved by a levels (keys), which can be high, medium and low, and pitch ranges
combination of lexical, syntactic and prosodic means. For example, (wide, medium and narrow). Loudness is described as normal, increased
rhythmicality may be created by repetitions, in which syntactic parallel­ (forte) or low (piano). Tempo includes rate of speech and pausation.
ism may be accompanied by the repetition of intonation patterns. The rate of speech can be normal, slow and fast. Pauses are classified ac­
In conclusion we must consider the problem of the acquisition of cording to their length, their position in the utterance (final - non-fi­
English rhythm by Russian learners of English. In spite of the fact that nal) and their function (syntactic, emphatic and hesitation pauses)
Russian belongs to the group of stress-timed languages as well as Eng­ Viewed on the acoustic level each component of intonation has its
lish, correct usage of English rhythm proves to be rather difficult for own acoustic correlate. The acoustic correlate of pitch is fundamental
Russian learners. The following aspects are to be considered here: frequency of the vibrations of the vocal cords; loudness correlates with
intensity, tempo correlates with time (duration) during which a speech
1. The traditional exercise that is recommended is to beat the rhythm so
unit lasts. All of them are closely interconnected in the processes of
that to practice regular rhythm. Despite the arguments among pho­
speech production and speech perception
neticians about the isochrony of English rhythm it is necessary to
The intonation pattern is the basic unit of intonation. It serves to
master stress-timed rhythm. Special focus in such exercises should
actualize syntagms into intonation groups. The nuclear tone is the most
be given to the contrast between stressed (strong) and unstressed
important part of the intonation pattern. The nuclear tone may be fol­
(weak) syllables, since it is a very important aspect of English
lowed by the tail. The two other components of the intonation pattern,
rhythm.
the head and the pre-head form its pre-nuclear part.
2. It is important to use weak forms in prepositions, articles, auxiliaries, Intonation is as a powerful means of communication. The commu­
conjunctions, personal and possessive pronouns, which generally nicative function of intonation embraces all its numerous uses, which
occur in unstressed positions. can be grouped into the following functions: distinctive or phonological;
organizing; pragmatic; rhetorical; social; stylistic.
3. Russian learners should be particularly careful in rhythm-unit break.
Performing its distinctive function intonation can differentiate the
The division into rhythmic groups does not necessarily coincide with
syntactic (communicative) types of sentences, attitudinal meanings, the
potential sense groups.
actual meaning of sentences.
4. For advanced learners it is essential to master the rhythmic organiza­ Intonation serves to structure the text. On the one hand, it delimi­
tion of larger rhythmic units with regard for the style and genre of tates the text into smaller units, on the other hand, it ties together small­
speech. er units into bigger ones.
Intonation conveys the information content of an utterance. It high­
lights the most important information in an utterance and helps to dis­
tinguish which information is new (the rheme) and which information is
Summary
known to the listener (the theme).
Intonation is a language universal. It is indispensable in communi­ Intonation plays a very important role in structuring spoken dis­
cation. course. At the same time it reflects the influence of the context, both
Intonation is defined as a complex, a whole, formed by significant verbal and extralinguistic, on the speech realization.
variations of pitch, loudness and tempo (the rate of speech and pausa­ Speech rhythm is defined as a regular occurrence of stressed sylla­
tion) closely related. The term "prosody" is used in suprasegmental bles in a speech continuum. English is a stress-timed language. In such
phonetics alongside with the term "intonation". languages rhythm is based on a larger unit than syllable, the rhythmic
Each component of intonation can be described as a system. Pitch is group. The stressed syllables in the rhythmic group form peaks of prom­
described as a system of tones (Fall, Rise, Fall-Rise and so on), pitch inence.
r

104 Chapter 1V. Intonation


Chapter V
Speech rhythm is regulated by the style of speech. Maximum rhyth­
micality is observed in poetry. Rhythm performs the functions of de­ PHONOSTYLISTICS
limitation and integration, aesthetic and pragmatic functions.

5.1. The problems of Phonostylistics


5.1.1. Phonostylistics as a branch of phonet­
ics
5.1.2. Extralinguistic situation and its compo­
nents
5.1.3. Style-forming factors
5.1.4. Classification of phonetic styles
5.2. Stylistic modifications of speech sounds
5.3. Stylistic use of intonation
5.3.1. Phonostyles and their registers
5.3.2. Informational style
a) spheres of discourse
b) informational texts (reading)
c) infonoational monologues (speaking)
d) informational dialogues
e) press reporting and broadcasting

5.3.3. Academic style


5.3.4. Publicistic style
5.3.5. Declamatory style. Artistic reading
5.3.6. Conversational style

5.1. The problems ofPhonostylistics

5.1.1. Phonostylistics as a branch of phonetics

So far we described phonetic units as part ofthe language system. When


language is used in speech phonetic units undergo various changes so it can
be assumed that pronunciation is not homogeneous. These variations of
phonetic units are the result of numerous factors which are referred to as
extralinguistic, because they lie outside the system of the language. The
bundle of these factors forms the extralinguistic situation.
106 Chapter V. Phonostylistics 5.1. The Problems of Phonostylistics 107

The chapter that follows is based on the idea that the information about level, which is the area ofphonostylistics. Its aim is to analyse all possible
stylistic variations is significant for teaching phonetics. The branch ofpho­ kinds of spoken utterances with the main purpose of identifying the pho­
netics which carries this information is phonostylistics. The purpose ofthis netic features, both segmental and suprasegmental, to explain why such
chapter is to offer a brief introduction into the main topics covered by pho­ features are used and to classify them into categories with regard for their
studies. It would not be accurate to say that phonostylistics is a function.
new branch of phonetics. It is rather a new way of looking at phonetic phe­
nomena, which came as a result of detailed analysis of spoken discourse.
5.1.2. Extralinguistic situation and its components
Nobody would want to deny the fact that oral speech is the primary me­
dium oflanguage expression. So when linguists became involved in investi­ Before describing nonlinguistic factors and their phonetic correlates it
gating language in use they realized that language is not an isolated phe­ is necessary to explain what is understood by the extralinguistic situation.
nomenon, it is part of society. In real life people fmd themselves in various The analysis shows that it can be described in term.'l of three component'l,
situations. In these situations language is used appropriately, i. e. people i. e. purpose, participants and setting. These components distinguish situa­
select from their total linguistic repertoires those elements which match the tions as the context in which speech interaction takes place. Thus, a speech
needs of particular situations. situation can be defmed by the co-occurrence of the following elements:
This fact changed the whole approach to the language. Rather than two or more participants related to each other in a particular way,
viewing the language as an object with independent existence, a thing to be particular aim of communication, communicating about a particuI<ll
described for its own sake, it became evident that it must be seen as a tool, in a particular way.
a means ofcommunication, and it is only in the context of communication Figure 12
situation that the essential properties of a linguistic system can be described Components of Extralinguistic Situation
and
"
It is obvious that much of what people say depends directly or indirect­ Extralinguistic situation
lyon the situation they are in. Here we should point out two things. On the
one hand, variations of language means in different life situations are nu­
purpose setting
merous, on the other hand, these variations have much in common as they
are realization of one system. That means that there are regular patterns of
variation in language, or, in other words, language means are characterized Let us consider each of the components.
by a certain pattern of selection and arrangement. Purpose can be described as the motor which sets the chassis ofpartici­
The principles ofthis selection and arrangement, the ways ofcombining and setting going. It directs the activities ofthe participants through­
the elements form what is called "the style". Style integrates language out the situation to complete a task. Such purposes can be viewed in terms
means constructing the utterance and at the same time differentiates one ofgeneral activity types and in terms ofthe activity type plus a specific sub­
utterance from another. ject matter. There appear to be a considerable number of general types of
It must be noted that the category of style is not new in linguistics. The activities, such as working, teaching, learning, conducting a meeting, play­
branch oflinguistics which is concerned with styles is called stylistics (func­ ing a game, etc. Such activity types are socially recognized as units ofinter­
tional stylistics), it studies the expressive potential ofthe language elements, action that are identifiable.
for the most part the levels of grammar and lexis. However, the phonetic It should be noted that activity type does not identifY directly the pur­
level has its own characteristics and qualities and needs specific methods of pose in a situation. It only specifies the range of possible purposes that par­
investigation. ticipants will orient toward in the activity. The notion of purpose requires
As it was already mentioned, certain nonlinguistic features can be the specification of contents as a more detailed level than that of activity
correlated with language use. The latter can be studied on the phonetic types. This can be called "subject matter" or "topic".
108 Chapter V. Phonostylistics 5.1. The Problems of Phonostylistics 109

By participants we mean people involved in communication. Speech is Another important aspect is the character of participants' relation­
a marker of various characteristics of people, both individual and social. In ship which is retlected in the tenor of discourse, which can be formal or
other words, the way people speak retlects their background. "Certain as­ informal, friendly or unfriendly. It affects greatly the choice of intona­
pects of social variation seem to be of particular linguistic consequence. tion.
Age, sex and social class have repeatedly shown to be ofimportance when it Speech behaviour also retlects the social roles that people exercise:
comes to explaining the way sounds, constructions and vocabulary vary" head ofthe family, son, teacher, friend and so on. So when we identify the
(D. Crystal, 1995: 364). social identity of a person and the way it is retlected in pronunciation we
Age can be associated with the role structure in the family and in social are to consider both his/her belonging to a particular social group and the
assignment ofauthority and status and with the attribution social roles he/she performs.
UlHvlvm levels of competence. According to D. Crystal, "age is one of Setting, or scene can be defined by several features: The first of them
the most noticeable features in speech. We have little difficulty identifying a is a physical orientation of participants, which is to some extent deter­
baby, a young child, a teen-ager, a middle-aged person, or a very elderly mined by the activity they are engaged in. It is quite obvious that a public
person from a tape recording" (D. Crystal, 2007: 283). The speech behav­ speech and face-to-face interaction are bound to be different in phonetic
iour ofa person does not only convey information about his/her age but also terms in a number ofways.
about the age ofthe listener, or the receiver ofthe verbal message. Thus, old Scenes may be arranged along bipolar dimension offormal-informal.
people speak and are spoken to in a different way from young people. For The kind of language appropriate to scenes on the formal, or "high" end
instance, an elderly person usually speaks in a high-pitched voice, the of the scale is then differentiated from that appropriate to those on the
speech rate is slower. People generally use higher pitch levels speaking to or "low" end. Comparing English and Russian we could assume
younger children. such differentiation follows universal principles, so that "high" forms
Gender is another factor which is included into the "partlclpants com­
U

oflanguage share certain properties such as elaboration of syntax and lex­


ponent. Gender differences in pronunciation are quite numerbus and in icon, phonetic precision and rhythmicality, whereas "low" forms share
most cases there is a marked phonetic contrast between male and female. properties including ellipsis, repetition, speed and slurring. So pronunci­
For instance, there is a tendency for women to produce more standard, ation features may be expected to be markers ofthe scene or at least of its
careful pronunciation as opposed to more careless speech of men in which position in the formal-informal dimension.
certain sounds may be omitted. Women tend to use certain intonation pat­
terns that are seldom used by men, etc. 5.1.3. Style-forming factors
There is one more characteristic to be taken into account. That is the
emotional state ofthe speaker at the moment ofspeech production which is We have attempted to give an outline of what is generally understood
likely to be retlected in his pronunciation. by the extralinguistic situation and its constituents. It is easy to see, how
Another characteristic to be considered here is the social status of the numerous the factors, determining variation in language usage, are. Ad­
participants, i. e. their belonging to a particular class, their education, oc­ mittedly, we are mainly interested in the variation of phonetic means. To
cupation and so on. There are distinctive features of pronunciation which analyze and describe them we must single out constant and definite fea­
are associated with "educated" and "uneducated" speech, tures of the situational circumstances of the lan!,'Uage event that are rele­
or absence of articulatory precision. Admittedly, "the famous linguistic vant for the phonetic level of analysis. These features, or factors, that re­
nal of social class in Britain is the pronunciation offinal ng in such words as sult in phonostylistic variety are:
running" (D. Crystal, 2007: 309). In socio-cultural terms we must consider - the purpose, or aim ofcommunication;
the social status ofthe speaker, what social group orc1ass he belongs to. Ob­ - the degree offormality of the situation;
viously, the pronunciation of an Oxford don will be very different from that - the degree of spontaneity;
of a London cab driver. - the speaker's attitude.
110 Chapter V Phonostylistics 5.1. The Problems ofPhonostylistics 111

We should mention here that the purpose, or aim of communication public or non-pUblic. Speech is qualified as public when the speaker is lis­
may be called a style forming factor, while all the others cause modifications tened to by a group of people; non-public communication occurs in face­
within a particular style, which accounts for the existence of different ldnds to-face interaction. It would be fair to mention that there is no direct cor­
and genres of texts within each phonetic style. relation between the formality of the situation and public - non-pUblic
All the above-mentioned factors are interdependent and interconnected. character ofcommunication. Thus, a public presentation may be rather in­
They are singled out with the purpose ofdescribing phonetic phenomena. formal, while speech interaction involving two participants may be quite
Now we shall consider each ofthe factors and try to explain what sort of formal.
phonetic variations may correlate with each of them. Another important extralinguistic factor is the degree of spontaneity. If
The aim ofcommunication can be described as the general strategy ofthe we examine speech situations we can distinguish between those in which
language user. In other words, it is what the language is being used for: is the people speak spontaneously as opposed to those in which they speak non­
speaker trying to persuade, to exhort, to discipline. Is the speaker teaching, spontaneously, as actors and lecturers generally do. The types of speech sit­
advertising, amusing, controlling, etc. ? The speaker selects a number of uations that lead to spontaneous speech are: everyday conversation, sports
functional phonetic means which would make the realization of the par­ commentaries of an event actually taking place and so on.
ticular aim more effective. Analyzing the most important characteristics of a spoken spontaneous
For the purposes ofthis book we consider it adequate to distinguish text we should first of all mention a phenomenon called "hesitation". The
following aims of communication: hesitation phenomenon breaks the regularity and evenness of the phonetic
giving information form. There appear pauses of various length and quality, which seldom oc­
- educating cur at phonetic juncture; lengthening of sounds within words and in the
- producing emotional impression word final position. A spontaneous text is characterized by a number of rel­
- influencing a person's mind (persuading) evant features both on segmental and suprasegmentallevels: simplification
- conversing. ofsound sequences, non-systematic rhythm; incomplete melody contours;
Inside these basic aims we can distinguish many more minor types, that abundance of pauses, varying loudness, narrow pitch range, varying tempo
cause variations of phonetic means. (from very fast to very slow).
Among the extralingustic factors determining the use ofphonetic means In teaching English, especially spoken English one should be well aware
it is the fonnality of the situation which is often referred to. It is obvious that of specific phonetic markers of natural speech. A student of English should
the process of speaking is based on the recognition of social roles and rela­ be specially taught such peculiarities. Otherwise a spoken text would sound
tionships. The interaction of individuals depends upon their learning and urmatural.
accepting the roles of social behaviour. Social relationships are reflected in The speaker's attitude is another category which is included into the set
the degree of formality of the discourse. The degree of formality indicates of style-forming factors. It is common knowledge that a communication
how the speaker interacts with the listener. situation is part of a human being's life situation. So it is natural for a lan­
As it was already mentioned, formality results from the character of re­ guage user to consider the situation from his/her point of view, revealing
lationships among the participants of language events, ranging from ex­ personal interest and involvement in what he or she is saying. Obviously, the
treme degrees of formality to extreme degrees of informality. So we might attitude ofthe speaker both to the message and to the other participants of
say that spoken language shapes relationships, it defmes and identifies them, communication is reflected in his/her choice of phonetic means.
and it is the category of formality which shows ifwe speak the right kind of We should mention that all these extralinguistic factors in their combi­
language. According to the degree offormaJity speech situations are gener­ nation determine the choice of phonetic means in different fonns of com­
ally described in terms offormal- informal, official unofficial. munication. Generally two forms of communication are distinguished ac­
There is another factor which is often mentioned in connection with cording to the number of participants involved in a speech activity:
the degree of formality. It is the number of addressees. Discourse can be monologue and dialogue. A monologue is the participation of one individ­
112 Chapter V. Phonostylistics 5.1. The Problems ofPhonostylistics 113

ual in speech production. A dialogue involves the participation of others. lish pronunciation. Further on we are going to look in more detail at the
An important feature to be considered here is that in monologuing the stylistic modifications of sounds and intonation and specify the particular
speaker does not expect an immediate response, while in a dialogue there is extralinguistic factors which bring about these modifications.
interaction: participants expect each other to respond. PhonostyJistic pecu­ Table 4
liarities ofdifferent forms of communication will be described in 5.3. The Influence of Extralinguistic Factors
on Segmental and Suprasegmental Characteristics of Speech
--
5.1.4. Classification of phonetic styles Phonetic units Extralinguistic factors
All the extralinguistic factors that were described contribute to the for­ Segmental (speech sounds) degree of formality, degree of spontaneity
mation of a particular phonetic style. It should be mentioned that there ex­ Suprasegmental (intonation) purpose of communication, degree offonnality, de­
ist different classifications of phonetic styles. Each of these classifications is gree of spontaneity, speaker's attitude
---­

based on the criterion, which the scholar who created it considers to be the
most reliable. Thus, S. M. Gaiduchick distinguishes five phonetic styles: Five phonetic styles can be singled out according to the purpose of com­
solemn (TOp)[(eCTBeHHbIH), scientific-business (Hay'mO-)l.eJ10Bolt), official munication:
business (TOp)[(eCTBeHHO-)l.eJ10Bolt), everyday (6bITOBOH) and familiar (He­ I. Informational style;
rrplfHY)[()l.eHHblli) (S. Gaiduchick, 1972) As we can see the above-men­ 2. Academic (Scientific) style;
tioned classification correlates with the system of functional styles of the 3. Publicistic (Oratorial) style;
language. The styles are differentiated on the basis of spheres of discourse. 4. Declamatory (Artistic) style;
A different principle of classification is suggested by Y A. Dubovsky who 5. Conversational (Familiar) style.
singles out the following five styles: informal ordinary, formal neutral, for­ Figure 13
familiar and declamatory. The divisioIi is based on Classification of Phonetic Styles
different degrees of formality or rather familiarity between the speaker and
the listener. Within each style subdivisions are observed. But as the author
himself writes, it is rather a principle of presenting texts for description and
analysis because "no theory has yet created a completely symmetrical clas­
sification of speech acts" (Y Dubovsky, 1978). informational
conversational
style
style
We think that the classification ofphonetic styles should be based on the
purpose of communication, which is the most significant extralinguistic
factor. However, when choosing an adequate criterion for the classification We could add that any style with very few exceptions is seldom real­
we should take into consideration the difference between the segmental and ized in its pure form. Each text is likely to include phonetic characteristics
suprasegmental levels of analysis. The point is that stylistic variations of of different styles. In such cases we talk about overlapping or fusion of
sounds and intonation result from different combinations of extralinguistic styles.
factors. Thus, stylistic modifications of sounds are caused primarily by the We might conclude by saying that we hope this will be a useful of
degree of formality, while variations of intonation are basically determined knowledge for a learner of English because to be able to communicate ef­
by the aim of communication. The degree ofthe influence of each factor is it is necessary to develop the awareness of different phonetic
also different as regards segmental and suprasegmental units. So in the clas­ styles of the language. He or she should learn to discover the patterns
sification of phonetic styles presented here we tried to combine both seg­ which differentiate style varieties to understand why people speak in a
mental and suprasegmental characteristics oforal discourse not only for the certain way and to determine what form of phonetic expression they may
purpose ofphonostylistic analysis but also for the purpose ofteaching Eng­ choose, because the style should be as natural as dress and fit the time, the
114 Chapter V Phonostylistics 5.2. Stylistic Modifications of Speech Sounds 115

place and the person. The awareness of phonostylistic variations ofspeech [d] are affected by the following [j] in a similar way: and turn into
is essential both for the correct interpretation of spoken discourse and for palato-alveolar affricates. Tn this case both the place and the manner of
the adequate speech production, in fact it is a basic component of speech articulation are involved in assimilation:
culture and communicative competence.
would you ['wud3U'] mind you ['mamd3u']

can't you ['ku:ntJu'] about you

5.2. Stylistic Modifications of Speech Sounds in informal casual speech complete assimilation of consonants often
takes place:
Stylistic sound variations are brought about by the extralinguistic
let me ['lemrnt] ten minutes ['tem'mmIis]

situation of the discourse. The first thing that counts in the stylistic
modifications ofsounds is the character of relationship between the par­
nice shoes ['nalf'Ju:z]

ticipants of discourse, which is manifested in the degree of formality. It [t] tends to be reduced to a glottal stop before a plosive consonant:
is assumed that in formal situations the participants tend to monitor didn't go ['dld!)?'kg3U] Great Britain ['rel?'pbrltn]
their linguistic behaviour, their pronunciation tends to be careful and is
characterized by articulatory precision. In informal situations where In fast colloquial speech we can also observe elision of consonants. Eli­
speakers are more relaxed speech is generally faster and less careful. In­ sion can be defined as a complete loss or disappearance of a speech sound,
formal speech used in everyday conversation is often referred to as fast usually due to the increased rate of speech. The most typical cases of con­
(rapid) colloquial speech. sonant elision are:
It is obvious that the extent to which coarticulation and simplifica­ elision of [h] in personal and possessive pronouns he, his, her, him and
tion processes are displayed in connected speech depends on the style the auxiliary verbs have, has, had: What has he done? [-7wutClZ r ,dAn];
and tempo of speech. In formal speech the articulation is more careful
and precise. In informal casual discourse (fast colloquial speech) these tends to be elided when preceded by [;x]: always [';XWIZ], all right
processes are more marked. In this section we shall give an overview of
the modifications of speech sounds in the chain of speech which take [t] and [d] are often elided in consonant clusters when followed by an­

place under the influence of the extralinguistic factors. other consonant: next day ['neks 'del], mashed potatoes ['m~J

The most frequent modifications of consonants in rapid colloquial next point [,neks 'p;)mt], second term ['sekn 't3:rn];

speech are:
in the definite article the can be elided: and the reason for this [Cln
alveolar stops [t], [d] and in some cases [n] are modified underthe in­ o'rtzn fCl OIS].
fluence ofthe following velar or labial consonant, e. g.
As regards stylistic modifications of vowels we should point out that the
that place ['o<ep 'pleIs] hardproblem ['hu:b 'prnblClm] realization of reduction as well as assimilation and accommodation depends
that book r'O<eD 'buk] hard blow ['hu:b 'b13u] on the style of speech. In rapid colloquial speech reduction may result
good morning [gug 'm;ml!)] vowel elision, the complete omission of the unstressed vowel. Elision may
[s], [z] assimilate more often than in formal speech, they are modified occur both within one word and at word boundaries: history ['hIstn], factory
under the influence of the following palatal [j] and become palato­ ['f~ktn], phonetics [f'netlks], correct [krekt], perhaps [ph<eps], come along

alveolar: ['k1l.m 'luI)] , get another [get 'n1l.0Cl], after all


In contrast to slow formal speech in which vowels have comparative
miss you as you [Cl3 ju:]
quality stability, in rapid informal speech we can observe frequent sound
this year
as yet [Cl3 jet] variability. Typical simplification processes in fast colloquial speech are:
116 Chapter V. Phonostylistics 5.3. Stylistic Use ofIntonation 117

reduction of [i:] and [u:] both in quantity and quality In our view the conception that the intonational style markers are restricted
to certain kinds of situational contexts and above all to the speakers' aim in
1 don't believe it [A daon(t)
communication is extremely valuable. Thus the intonational style is seen as
a new aspect [a 'n(j)u
some kind of additive by which a basic content of thought may be modified.
monophthongization of diphthongs Style is seen asthe variable means by which a message is communicated.
here and there ['hIr an '0£] It is already widely accepted that the purpose of communication deter­
really strange ['[ah 'stremd3] mines the types of information conveyed in oral texts. They may be intel­
now they ['na lectual, attitudinal (emotional, modal) and volitional (desiderative). Each
South ofItaly ['sa9 av 'dahl of these types is realized by means of specific prosodic parameters.
and now we come to [an nA wr 'kAm ta] It may be said that there is a strongly marked tendency for prosodic fea­
hope to settle it [ha ta tures to form a basic set of recurrent patterns, which is occasionally accom­
panied by the introduction of specific prosodic and paralinguistic effects.
elision of schwa in the preposition or particle to: The set of stylistically marked modifications of all the prosodic features
next to the door ['nekst t oa 'dJ:] represents the model ofa particular phonetic style.
to see them ['ts!" It should be mentioned here that each phonetic (intonational) style ex­
back to London ['b<ek t 'iAndn] ists in a number of variants which depend on a particular combination of
extralinguistic factors. We call these variants registers. Registers can be ob­
elision of [I] in initial position
served in specific spheres of discourse.
extremely [kstri:mh] Prosodic characteristics which form the model of a particular style are
it's necessary [is 'nesasan] modified according to the forms of communication (monologue, dialogue,
it's paid well [ts polylogue) and the types of speech production (speaking and reading), the
Numerous simplification processes that were described are an attribute of degree of spontaneity and formality and also in some cases methods of de­
informal casual speech, while prepared educated speech is characterized by livery (see Tables 5, 6).
articulatory precision. In terms of pronunciation teaching it is necessary to We must admit, however, that any intonational style is an extremely
familiarize the foreign learners of English with these segmental modifica­ complex and heterogeneous phenomenon. Even a single speech act involves
tions, because they must be ready to recognize and decode them in the chain an extraordinary range of factors and could be considered from different,
ofspeech. However, they should be aware oftheir stylistic colouring and avoid sometimes even conflicting points of view.
extreme forms ofsimplifications outside fast colloquial speech.. As regards the . Confronted with all these difficulties a specialist in phonostylistics must
modifications of speech sounds that are the result ofcoarticulation processes ask himself/herself what the goal of analysis is and direct his/her attention
in connected speech they should definitely be practised and mastered. .to the essentials. In this book the description will be focused on those style
forming features that may be of interest for would-be teachers of English
and find practical application in their work.
5.3. Stylistic Use of Intonation Figure 14
The Role of the Degree of Formality in Phonetic Style Formation

5.3.1. Phonostyles and their registers

This section sets out to give a detailed description of each phonetic ~onal informal L_
style, to provide and explain a framework for understanding variations of
style which match the needs of particular situations. Conversational I Academic
118 Chapter V. Phonostylistics 5.3. Stylistic Use of Intonation 119

5.3.2. Informational Style Table 5

a) spheres of discourse .l= '9 I


:g g
I

!!
I I
,!.
01 ._

...-5 -­
~-= =-,;
I

phonetIC style is sometimes qualified as "neutral", since it is the least e =-~ 'Q'E
marked kind of situationally influenced English. It is perceived as neutral be­
Speech typology <:>
'Q
<.I
...=­<:> '"'" <:> ~
.8 .9

~!
r!l
:§~ ~.§
cause the main purpose ofthe speaker is to convey information without the ex­
pressing personal concern and involvement. Evidently, there are theoretical and
.
~b.()
~
.e~
'" =:
!..§ b.()~
Q.I 01
QCI.
~ Zl
z!. '!'!j
u;'"
,
practical reasons to use it as the starting point ofphonetic styles description. b.()

Where is this style manifested in its pure form? First of all, in the written
variety of an informational text read aloud. The written speech, the reading, Informational
. .....,=
~
~
<Il
=
g <.I
:=
-=~
I8. ..
~
i style registers b.()

= <:> ~
..., = 1 l l
~ .s.
S
should not be subjected to the contextual variables and the commonest and
~~ ~ ~
Q.I
<:>
t ~
CI.
-;
"ideal" situation for this register is the reading ofsuch texts in class. They may ~ ;a ~
CI. =
=­ :§ I

'"
be labeled as informational texts. Educational in­
Press reporting and broadcasting, especially the reading ofthe news cov­ formation
+ + + + + + + + + + + I
erage over the radio is another variant ofinformational style.
The news bulletin and broadcast talk have both written and spoken
tences which are of equal importance for the simple reason that they were
Press reporting
and broadcasting
,----­
+ + + + + + + + + +
L
written specially to be read aloud. The informational style is realized in other
spheres ofcommunication: business and legal intercourse, thli reading of ad­ Table 6
ministrative documents and so on (see Table 5).
\1lrieties of the language and forms of communication
The degree of formality in the character of participants' relationship in
different variants ofthe informational style presentation may smooth the bor­ Written variety of the language
Spoken variety of the language (Speaking)
Spheres (Reading)
derline between them. Thus it would be wrong to identifY this style as formal, of dis­
-----~-~-

because the degree offormality may vary. As it was stated earlier, the contours Monologue Dialogue Monologue Dialogue Polylogue
course
of the intonational styles in speech reality have not been very defmitely out­ (Regis­ .s.!
~
~=­
OJ
:= .s.!
ters) ::.c
lined yet and there are overlaps ofphonetic styles. So the most informal real­ t, '@
i=:
=­ ...:== ...=
~
~I~
.s.! <.I <.I .s.!
:= .l<:>=
I I
=: ::.c
ization ofany kind ofinformation in the form of a dialogue may be identified
as conversational style, and, respectively, extra formal presentation of infor­
i ~ 1 =: =­ 8 CI. 8 =
=-
Educa- Reading Read- Read­ - Speak- Talk- Talk- Just Round­ -
mation may be attributed to an academic style talk and so on. tional in class ingto ingin ing ingto ingin talking table
We shall limit out description ofinformational style to two common vari­ infor­ a lis­ class public a lis­ class talks
ants: educational information and press reporting/broadcasting. The table mation tener tener
-
below shows the correlation between the informational style registers, and Press Reading Read­ - - Talk- Talk- Com- Just Round­ -
speech typology (see Table 5). report- news ing ingon ingto ment­ discus- table
ingand cover- news- the a lis­ ingon sing talks of
Roughly speaking, any variety of the language, both written and spoken, broad- age over paper events tener the the commen­
may be presented either by reading or speaking in a prepared or spontaneous casting the ra­ to a over events, events tators
way in a formal or informal manner. dio, Tv, lis­ the TV discus-
reading tener sing I
We would like to attempt now to suggest certain spheres of discourse in newspa­ them I
which the informational style could be heard in relation to forms of com­ perin
munication and the number of participants involved (see Table 6). class I
120 Chapter V. Phonostylistics 5.3. Stylistic Usc ofIntonation 121

Now that we have outlined the contours of the style, our next step cational purposes to stimulate pupils or students for prose and poetry
will be to analyse prosodic characteristics of this particular intonational appreciation and comprehension. Needless to say a written passage does
style. The following prosodic parameters should be considered: pitch not always coincide with a phonopassage. In reading aloud a written
(variations of pitch direction, pitch level, pitch range), loudness, tempo passage may be broken into several phonopassages or, on the contrary,
(the rate of the utterance and pausation). It also includes rhythm and short passages may be combined into one long lasting phonopassage.
timbre as they have very specific suprasegmental expression of various As it has been mentioned, reading and speaking differ totally in the
emotional, expressive and evaluative overtones. speech production activity. In teaching to read we are simply helping to
It would be fair to admit here that when faced with a text of some transfer from one medium to another. Reading and speaking each re­
kind what appears to be a mass of coordinated data a starting point quires differently directed intensive efforts. Obviously, the phonetic fea­
for analysis is often difficult to choose. tures of these varieties of texts will show considerable differences.
As it was suggested above, the ideal start is an informational text, We would like to start the phonostylistic analysis of the reading of
most commonly heard in class. The analysis of it here is carried out by the text, in which some customs and traditions of Cambridge University
the procedure of systematic phonological opposition: the phonostylistic life are described.
organization of reading will be systematically compared with the spoken
version (in the forms of a monologue and dialogue). May Week in Cambridge
The description of the informational phonetic style will proceed in (Reading)l
the following order: The -+most 'interesting and bi'zarre time of the year to visit ,Cambridge
1. The phonostylistic analysis of the written informational texts I is during ,May Week. II This is -+neither in ,May, I nor it is a II For
(reading). I -+some ,reason \ which nobody now re>members I 'May Week is the 'name
2. The analysis of the spoken variety of such texts. 'given to the t first 'two 'weeks in June. I the -+very end of the University
3. Comparative analysis of spoken and written informational mono­ 'year. III
logues. The "'paradox is "'pleasantly 'quaint. I but is "'also "'in a way "'{!]!1. II
"'May Week denotes 'not so much a particular 'period q(,time I as the "'gen­
eral'atmosphere ofreldxation and un,winding \ at the -+end of the year's
b) informational texts (reading)
I
recent years it has become fashionable in education to extol the
importance ofspoken language with a depreciation ofthe values of read­ Any phonostylistic analysis falls into several steps. Obviously the
ing, consequently the skill in reading now is often inadequate. This situ­ first procedure will be the description ofthe speech situation which com­
ation needs considerations. As was stated, there is a gap between spoken prises the purpose, setting and participants. In reference to this text we
and written varieties of the language and the task of the teacher is to dif­ may say that the main purpose of the reader is to give information. The
ferentiate these forms of the language appropriate to speech and writing speaker sounds dispassionate and rather reserved.
and to assign to each their "proper" sphere. It is perhaps just to say that The presenter of the text is a student of Oxford University who has
many teachers and lecturers recognize the gap but are unable to improve advanced RP accent. The reading is addressed to a group of students,
this state of affairs because of the lack of materials and methods. Russian learners of English.
These two varieties of the language are a result of two activities that The next step is to define other extralinguistic factors, the degree of
differ in psychological and intellectual terms. preparedness among them. The analysed text may be characterized as
Talking is easier than the laborious solitary acts of reading. The re­ half prepared as it was read through beforehand.
luctant reader will have to be given more cogent reasons for the eftorts
required to him. Reading aloud is even harder. In class it has purely edu­ communicative centre of a phrase

communicative centre of a phonopassage

122 Chapter V. Phonostylistics 5.3. Stylistic Use ofIntonation 123

Now we shall look at the prosodic characteristics. One should un­ Table 7
doubtedly begin Prosodic Characteristics of Informational Texts Reading
then into phrases, then into intonation groups, correspondingly, the
VOice colouring The speaker sounds impartial, dispassionate, reserved,
of pauses is varied according to the textual units. Pauses are made resonant
within the phrase and between them.
Delimitation The text is divided into phonopassages - phrases ­ inter­
Among the prosodic features we should mention the following: national groups; pauses are mostly at syntacticaljuncturcs,
Loudness is relatively stable and normal, but close to the phonopas­ normally of medium length but for the end of the passage
sage boundaries there is a gradual decrease of it. Thus it is easy to spot Style-marking Loudness normal (piano) throughout the text, varied at the pho­
the boundaries by loudness contrasts between the final and initial into­ prosodic nopassage boundaries
nation groups of two adjacent phonopassages. The same could be said features
Levels and decrease ofleveL, and ranges within the passage
about levels and ranges: there is a distinctly marked decrease of them ranges
within the phonopassage. Rate normal (moderate) or -slow, not variable
The rate of utterances is normal or rather slow, not noticeably var­ Pauses mostly syntactical of normal length, occasional emphatic
ied. Together with the medium length of pauses the general tempo may ones for the semantic accentuation
be marked as moderate. Rhythm systematic, properly organized isochronic, decentralized
The rhythm may be characterized as systematic, properly organized, accentuation
interpausal stretches have a marked tendency towards the rhythmic iso­ Accentuation Terminal tones common use offmal categoric falls; in non-final segments
chrony. of semantic mid-level and low rising tones are often used
centres
One of the main style differentiating feature) on the prosodic level is Pre-nuclear common u'>c offalling and level heads or several falls within
patterns one interpausal unit
the accentuation of the semantic centres. It is expressed commonly by
Contrast be­ not great
terminal tones, pre-nuclear patterns, pitch range and pitch level, degree
tween accent­
of loudness on the accented syllables, and also by the contrast between edand unac­
the accented and non-accented segments of the utterance. As regards cented
this particular text we may say the following: segments
The most common terminal tone is a
expressive high falls are used; in c) informational monologues (speaking)
low-rising ones are
Much has been said earlier about the differences between reading and
The -+most 'interesting and bi'zarre time ofthe year to visit ,Cambridge
speak.ing. Our aim here is to demonstrate them on the prosodic level using
is during ,May Week.
concrete examples. Now the text "May Week in Cambridge" was repro­
duced spontaneously by the same speaker in the form of a monologue. He
Pre-nuclear patterns are not greatly varied: falling and level types of
did it in a rather formal manner and addressed the same group ofstudents.
heads prevail. Several falls within an intonation group are typical:
The "'paradox is "'pleasantly 'quaint I but is "'also "'in a way 'apt. II May Week in Cambridge
(Reproduction)
The contrast between accented and unaccented segments of phrases -+As you probably >know I the uni"'versities of'Oxford and ,Cambridge I are
is not great, which is known to be a marker of any reading in general; the the -+two 'oldest universities in I and be-+c;ause of>that, I because of
stress is decentralized, i. e. equally distributed on accented syllables of their ,age I they have -+many which to Joreigners \ might -+appear
pre-nuclear patterns. very ,strange. II-+One ofthese tra>ditions I is 'May Week in 'Cambridge. III This
124 Chapter V. Phonostylistics 5.3. Stylistic Use oflntonation 125

is par'licu/ar/y ~trange I as it "'doesn't 'happen in ,May I and is "'not in 'fact a Terminal tones are fmal and categoric, the emphasis being achieved by
II It "'stretches 'over 'two weeks, the and the '8h weeks ofthe 'term. II the use of high (medium) abrupt falls, or several falls within one interpausal
There is 'no 'real 'reason for 'calling it May, Week land per>haps \it is "'herald­ unit. Low rising and Mid-level tones are common for initial or non-final
ing the 'coming of'Mav I which is till "'then \ in yavour of'more intonation groups to bind them together into a phrasal unit:
'serious matters \ like exami'nations. III There're many ....different ac.(ivities I In >Oxford I we don't have a ,May Week. II
which ....go on during ,May,Week Ifor the "'most 'part there are 'many >plays
on by indi"'vidual'college so,ciefies, I "'very often 'taking place out,doors I in Types of heads are varied: level heads of one accentuated pre-nuclear
....College 'gardens. III There are 'also Iwith ....crews of,eight I com­ prevail, sometimes several partially accented syllables occur be­
peting in 'bumping races. III What [ ....mean races I is when the ,aim is tween them. Descending falling heads are also quite common, they are oc­
>to I >bump I back ofthe 'boat I in front ofyou on the ....Cam ,river. II casionally broken by the "accidental rise":
'Personally I I come from 'Oxford University, Iso ....1 know tfar more about
The purpose of the communication in the setting described accounts for 'Oxford. II
the businesslike, dispassionate, detached, impartial voice colouring. Occa­
sionally, the speaker sounds interested, involved, especially, when he speaks As the monologue is quite spontaneous the contrast between accented
about his own experiences. and non-accented segments is great; centralized type of stress helps to un­
Speaking about the delimitation of spoken texts it should be pointed out derline the semantic centres:
that it depends on the degree ofspontaneity. The basic writ ofa spoken mono­ This is par'ticularly ~trange I as it "'doesn't 'happen in ,May I and is "'not in
logue is also a 'phonopassage but its stretch is greatly varied, much greater than 'fact a 'week. II
in reading. As in oral speech the rules of syntax are not strictly followed, pas­
sages are broken into utterances which do not often coincide with sentences. Now the auditory analysis of various informational monologues and
Pauses at the end ofthe phrase are commonly optional; hesitation pauses often phonetic research allow us to conclude that this description may be applied
break a syntagm into several intonation groups and occur both intentionally to the majority ofspoken monologues produced within the register and may
and non-intentionally. They may be filled and non-filled (silent): be treated as a model informational spoken monologue.

What I ....mean ,bumping races I is when the ,aim is >to I >bump \ ....back ofthe Table 8
'boat \ in front ofyou I on the ....Cam ,river. III Prosodic Characteristics of Infonnational Monologue (Speaking)
As the speaker addresses a comparatively small group of people the
loudness is not greatly varied but for the decrease towards the end of the \bice colouring The speaker sounds
dispassionate, hll~ine~~like. reserved, occasionally in­
passage. The increase ofloudness is evident at the start of the phonopassage
terested
and on its emphatic communicative centres. This may be also referred to --------------­

levels and ranges. I 2


The rate ofutterances is remarkably varied. In the majority of cases it is Delimitation The text is divided into
phonopassages phrases - intonation groups; a num­
normal, but increases towards allegro on less significant units and decreases
ber of hesitation and breath~taking pauses (filled and
towards lento on emphatic centres of the phrase or supraphrasal units. silent) break phrases into a great number of intonation­
The length of pauses depends on their syntactical and semantic value, al groups, destroying their syntactic structure
the maximum length being at the passage boundaries.
Style- Loudness normal (or piano); contrastive at the passage boundar­
This spoken monologue is characterized by non-systematic rhythrni­ marking ies; diminuendo (decrease) towards the end oht; in-
cality; the rhythmicality within the phonopassage is achieved by the prosodic crease ofloudness on semantic centres
nation of all prosodic parameters. features
126 Chapter V. Phonostylistics 5.3. Stylistic Use ofIntonation 127

Table 8 (Continued) 5. In spontaneous speech an intonation group doesn't always coincide


with a syntagm. Pauses at the end ofthe phrase are optional.
Style- Levels and decrease oflevels and ranges within the passage; various
6. The reading is characterized by a decentralized stress distribution
marking ranges ranges and levels bind together several successive se­
prosodic quences into a larger unit whereas speaking - by a centralized one.
features 7. In spontaneous speech communicative centres are more vividly empha­
Rate variable, allegro on interpolations, lento on emphatic
semantic centres
sized; the emphasis is achieved by a wider range of terminal tones,
greater degree ofloudness and prominence of accented segments.
Pauses varied, the length depends on the syntactical and se­
8. The reading is rhythmical, oral speech rhythm is non-systematic, un­
mantic value of the segment, the maximum length be­
ing at the passage boundaries predictable, variable.
Rhythm non-systematic, subjective isochrony, centralized
stress distribution, the rhythmicality within the pho­
nopassage is achieved by the alternation of all prosod­ Table 9
ic features Comparison of Intonation Models of Informational Monologues
Accen­ Terminal common use of final categoric falls on semantic cen­
tuation of tones tres, non-fmal falls, mid-level and rising tones on non- Phonostystic Varieties of the language
semantic final intonation group; the emphasis is achieved by the characteristics Reading Speaking
centres use of high falls (very abrupt for a male voice)
1 2 3
Pre-nuclear varied, common use oflevel heads with one accentuat­
Voice impartial, dispassion- dispassionate, businesslike, re­
patterns ed pre-nuclear syllable; descending falling heads are of­
colouring ate, reserved resonant served, occasionally interested
ten broken by the "accidental rise"
Delimitation phonopassages ­ phonopassages - phrases - into­
The contrast great, achieved by the centralized stress pattern, in­
phrases - intonation nation groups; a number ofhe sit a­
between ac­ crease ofloudness, levels and ranges on semantic cen­
groups; pauses are tion and breath-taking pauses
cented and tres, high categoric falls; emphatic stress on them and
mostly at syntactical (filled and non-filled) break
unaccented other variations of all prosodic characteristics
junctures normally of phrases into a great number of in­
segments
medium length, but for tonation groups, destroying their
the end of the passage syntactic structure
Our task now is to compare the prosodic characteristics ofthe two vari­
Other Loud- normal (piano) normal (piano), contrastive at the
eties ofthe language in this register. The results ofthe comparison are shown style­ ness throughout the text, boundaries, decrease towards the
in Table 9. marking varied at the phonopas­ end of the passage; increase on se-
We can make the following conclusion: prosodic sage boundaries mantic centres
1. Written text (read aloud) and spoken text belonging to the same pho­ features Levels decrease of levels and decrease oflevels and ranges with­
netic style have different prosodic realizations. and ranges within the pas­ in the passage; various ranges and
2. In oral speech prosodic characteristics are more vivid, expressive and varied. ranges sage levels bind together several se­
3. The speaker often uses some hesitation phenomena (hesitation pauses, quences into a larger unit
semantic noises and temporizers) intentionally, which enables him to Rate normal (moderate) or variable; allegro on interpolations,
obtain the balance between formality and informality and establish con­ slow, not variable lento on emphatic centres
tact with the public. Pauses not greatly varied, varied; the length depends on the
4. The speaker uses various hesitation phenomena unintentionally which mostly syntactical, oc­ syntactical and semantic value of
enables him to gain the time in search for suitable expression or idea casionallyemphatic the segment, the maximum length
and thus not interrupt the flow of speech. being at the passage boundaries
128 Chapter V. Phonostylistics 5.3. Use ofIntonation 129

throat, snorts, sniffs, laughs and other paralinguistic features of signifi­


cance.
On the lexical and grammatical level there is a comparatively high
proportion of errors which do not seem to bother the speakers.
Interpolations are commonly inteJjectional, their function is primarily
to indicate that attention is being maintained.
We should also mention here all sorts of introductions, afterthoughts,
By way ofconclusion we would advise future teachers of English to drift parenthetical words.
the traditional, non-stylistic approach to the language teacbing in Dialogues are commonly characterized by a large number of loosely
tbeir future practical work and pay special attention to tbe differences be­ coordinated clauses, the coordination being stmcturally ambiguous, and
tween the two varieties of the language. loosely coordinated sentence-like structures.
The phonostylistic analysis of a sample of informational dialogue will
allow us to single out the prosodic distinctive features, marking this variety
d) informational dialogues
of dialogues.
Now we shall focus on the dialogues within the sphere of the informa­ The talk is about two oldest universities of Britain - Oxford and Cam­
tional style discourse. bridge. This is a mono-thematic talk, though the speakers display some ob­
It is quite obvious that there are certain things common to all dialogues vious differences of opinion on the subject matter.
as opposed to monologues and we would like to describe them here.
Firstly, a dialogue is a coordinated simultaneous speech act of two par­ Oxford and Cambridge Universities
ticipants or rather a speaker and a listener. In this form of communication
A: I think some .....people might be interested >to \ oknow Iwhat>the \prin­
participants expect eacb otber to respond and conversation is controlled by
cipal 'differences are \ between the "'sort ofedu'cation you >get I at . . .Oxford
generally accepted rules of speech behaviour. The most important of them is
and ,Cambridge I and "'any 'other 'type of Uni'versity edu,cation. II
taking conversational turns. It is essential that in any successful conversation
B: > Um... 11
"give-and-take" between the sender and receiver should be maintained.
A: > What? \ '" What:y the 'sort of>thing \ that you would 'hif!hlighl? II
The attention-getting function is established by putting all sorts ofques­
B: ,Natura/JJ!. \ >difJerences I in
tions, agreement question tags to show the interest and guide the course of
A: 'Yes. "
the talk towards a given theme and also by using all sorts of response
B: I sup,pose... I
non-response words and utterances both of verbal and non-verbal charac­
A: >Well, I what the university one. I >Why, \for example one would
ter. The speakers sometimes talk simultaneously. The utterances tend to be
>choose... II
incomplete since the context can make perfectly plain to them what was be­
B: Ah, I I ,see. II
ing intended thus making redundant its vocal expression.
A: Xes ... to "'go to 'one ofthose uni>versities \ orapp'ly to one ofthose universi­
Hesitation phenomena are of primary significance in dialogues. Voice­
ties \ "'other to 'take the 'extra exam. II
less hesitation is very frequent, it tends to occur relatively randomly, not just
B: ,Yes. II >Er, I ,certainly, I >er, I I thinkjust >this I is 'social life in inverted
at places of major grarnmaticaljunctions, which is more the pattern ofwrit­
'commas >is \ >er \ a >very I thing about the university \ >which
ten English read aloud. \biced hesitation consists of hesitant drawls, verbal
in a way's I "'certainly a I part of edu'cation you rej:eive I when you go to
and non-verbal fillers such as el, ehm, mm.
'Oxford or 'Cambridge ... II
Dialogue is often accompanied by means of non-verbal communica­
A: The tu.. . torial ,system I I >think I is a good system I >which's
tion facial expressions (a raised eyebrow, a glance towards the partner,
been \par"'ticularly "'finely 'turned up in (bford and ,Cambridge...
etc.), gestures, body movements and noises such as artificial clearing of the
B: Xa. II
130 Chapter V Phonostylistics 5.3. Stylistic Use ofIntonation 131

A: ...though it ,does exist in ,other universities. II You have a "'great 'deal more Occasional emphatic pauses and frequent use of hesitation pauses (both
,freedom I about what you are going >to \ "'what 'course of >study you are filled and silent) are also characteristic of this talk:
pre-+cisely going to >follow. II
B: ,Ya.11 B: .Yes. II >Er, I ,certainly, I>er, II thinkjust >this I'social life in inverted 'com­
A: There's "'very much 'left >to \one's own ,choice. You >have... II In 'my course mas \ >is \ >er \ a >very at'tractive thing about the university...
I remember II could look up -+pages and 'pages ofthings that I could poten­
tially ,do. II Among style-marking prosodic features we should mention the follow­
B: ,Yes. II ing:
A: It was -+really just a ,question of ,one .sitting 'out I what I "'really wanted to Loudness is normal or reduced (piano), varied at the block boundaries.
,tin. III Important variation in loudness suggests the degree of seriousness of the
thematic information. Sometimes the speakers lower their voices to an in­
The participants are post-graduates, students ofthe Russian language of audible mumble or simply trail off into silence, which is undoubtedly con­
Oxford and Cambridge Universities who know each other quite well. They nected with changes in levels and ranges that are lowered and narrowed for
are in the same age group (mid-twenties) and share the same university ed­ many monosyllabic responses.
ucational background as mature students. The rate is flexible as the speakers wish it to be. A speaks very slowly, B ­
They discuss quite spontaneously a serious topic, in which they are a bit faster, but for both of them the speed is characteristically uneven.
competent, interested, but not emotionally involved and concerned. The rhythm is non-systematic, greatly varied, interpausal stretches have
The subject matter is serious and the speakers sound rather formal, a marked tendency towards subjective rhythmic isochrony; rhythmicality
businesslike, but occasionally interested and even involved. within the block is achieved by the variation of all prosodic parameters.
To maintain contact the participants use words like: yes, right, sure, of The accentuation of semantic centres is achieved by the use of emphat­
course, expressing immediate reaction as well as all kinds of non-verbal ic and compound tones (High Falls, Fall-Rises, Fall + Rises), increase of
sounds and noises like hm, mm, er, um, aha, etc. loudness, widening of the range of nuclei, changes in the rate of utterances
The speakers are relaxed and not worried about the impression they are and by a great contrast between accented and unaccented segments of
creating unlike a lecturer or a public speaker. Slips and errors of grammar phrases.
occur and do not bother them. Similarly, slight carelessness of pronuncia­ Pre-nuclear fragments are usually very short - heads with one accented
tion is common, thus we may speak about occasional deviations from the pre-nuclear syllable are most common. High pre-heads occur very often.
elaborated code. The observations made during the auditory analysis of this dialogue and
As any dialogue is a simultaneous act on the part of the sender and ad­ a great number of similar dialogues allow us to sum up the phonostylistic
dressee' they are both mutually dependent and adapt to each other's strate­ characteristics of informational spontaneous dialogues.
gies. Intonation contributes to establishing and maintaining contact be­
Table 10
tween the participants.
Prosodic Characteristics of Informational Spontaneous Dialogues
The dialogue falls into coordinated blocks, split into dialogical units
(stimulus - response). Each unit is characterized by semantic and phonetic Voice businesslike, detached, occasionally interested
integrity, by certain prosodic interrelated features. The ends of utterance colouring
pauses are frequently absent due to the rapid taking up cues: Delimi­ coordinated block - dialogical units (stimulus ­ re­
tation sponse) - phrases - intonation groups, frequent absence
B: Isuppose of end-of-utterance pauses due to the rapid taking up of
A: Well, what the university offers one. fJihy, for example one would choose... cues; frequent use of hesitation pauses (filled and silent),
B: Oh,Isee. occasional silence for purposes of emphatic pause
132 Chapter V. Phonostylistics 5.3. Stylistic Use ofIntonation 133

Table 10 (Continued)
2. In a dialogue there is a wider range ofcontrasts in prosodic and paralin­
Loudness nonnal or reduced (piano expression); variation ofit at
guistic effects.
block boundaries and also for the accentuation of semantic 3. In a dialogue there is a strong tendency to keep the utterances short, to
centres; occasional inaudible lowered mumbles and trailing break up potentially lengthy intonation groups wherever possible. The
off into silence occurring by the end ofthe segments average length of units in the majority of cases falls within the range of
--------------------------

Levels and especially for the contrastive accentuation words. Relatively high proportion of incomplete phrasal segments
ranges of semantic centres; narrowed pitch ranges for many is noticeable. Phrases are commonly short at the beginning, longer as
topics are introduced, longer still as argument develops and short again
Rate slow or
as the end approaches.
and interpolations, I.l1i:1.1i:l.I.lvj uneven, as flexible 4. In a dialogue there is no stable pattern of rhythm.
as one wishes it to be
5. The tempo (rate + pauses) in a monologue is normally less varied but in
Pauses may be of any length; their length being the marker of both cases it is conditioned by the importance of information, the flu­
contact between the speakers; simultaneous speaking is ency of speakers, their familiarity with the topic (theme) and experi­
quite common; silence ofany stretch occurs for the sake
ence in speaking. In general in a monologue slower speech is expected.
of emphasis and as a temporizer to gain some time before
the view By way of conclusion we would like to say that informational style is
Rhythm non-systematic, greatly varied, interpausal stretches have widely used in classroom interaction which makes it a useful model for
a marked tendency towards the subjective rhythmic i80­ teaching and learning the production of spoken English.
chrony; rhythmicality within the block is achieved by the
variation of all prosodic parameters
~------+---------~~~~~~~~~.~~~~~~~~~. ------ e) press reporting and broadcasting
Accen­ Terminal regular use offalling (high and medium) final and cate­
tuation tones goric tones, the increase of the range of the nuclei on the It has already been stated above that press reporting and broadcasting is
ofse­ semantic centres; occasional usage oflevel and low rising
a rather complicated non-homogeneous phenomenon and may be varied
mantic tones in non-fmal groups, of emphatic tones (High Fall,
centres Fall-Rise, Rise-Fall) on emphatic semantic centres; high from the stylistic point of view.
nr£vnrvrti.-." of narrow ranges throughout the responses The chief function of a newspaper and news bulletin is to inform, to
I-------lc~c~~~

Pre-nuclear common use oflevel heads, usually with one accented pre­ present a certain number of facts to a reader, a listener, or a viewer with the
patterns and high pre-heads, longer pre-nuclear effect of giving the impression of neutral, objective, factual reporting. All
do occur, then sudden types of discourse in that style share some important prosodic features.
within the segments characterize them
--------------~~~
It should be noted, however, that the speech of radio and television an­
The contrast the variations in all prosodic parame­ nouncers is somewhat different, because a TV news reader accompanies
betweenac­ vocal expression by non-verbal means of communication (facial expres­
cented and sion, gestures). The radio announcer tends to exaggerate certain prosodic
unaccented features to be better understood by the listeners.
segments
Here is an example of radio news coverage:
Comparing informational monologue - dialogue l'HUHU"LY -"Thirty-five vvehicles \ 'were in"'volved in a tmultiple col'Usion \ on the
acteristics we can make the following conclusions: "'M 'I 'motorway this omorning. II The -"accident oc>curred I about "'three miles
1. The structural hierarchy of a monologue is: phonopassages - phrases of the 'Newsport 'Pagnell vservice area I when an ar-"ticulated vlm:!:J:. I
intonation groups; whereas the one of a dialogue is: dialogue blocks "'carrying a 'load of-ySteel bars I 'j1JJ:kknifgd and II A "'number of
dialogue units - phrases - intonation groups. 'lorry drivers and vmotorists II were un,able to pull J!Jl in time I and ran 'into the
134 Chapter V Phonostylistics 5.3. Stylistic Use ofTntonation 135

overturned v vehicle l-tcausing g/tll!Jilg/pikup. III "'Some ofthe 'steel barsfrom close connection is expressed by the use of the Low Rising Tone in the ini­
the >load I were -+flung by the .Impact I across the 'central re'serve into the tial intonation group:
'southbound vcarriagewav I which was re-tStricted to 'single-lane 'working be­
cause of re'pairs and re- v swfacing I >causing I "'several 'minor ,accidents. I At the "'opening 'meeting in ,London olast ,night I Sir -+John Stone... 'criti­
With "'both 'carriageways vblocked Ipolice the motorwayfor a ,time Iand I the "'standard of'motorway driving in this ,country. He ,said that there
di"'version signs were 'posted at the 'nearest roads. III "'Breakdown 'vehicles was ,evidence I that "'many ofthe 'basic 'disciplines of ,motorwav use I had yet
and vambulances I had con-tsiderable >difJiculty I in reaching the 'scene ofthe to be vlearned I by British ,drivers.
,accident I because of'fgg· II This was in I and the 'flashing 'am­
ber ,/ightsignals Ihad been -+switched ,on \for-tmostofthe ,night. So jar Ithere One can see here that in the text sentences are not long and not compli­
are -+no re>ports I of"'anyone 'seriously \ in the II cated in their structure. The intonation groups are quite short so that the
listener would not lose thread of what is being reported.
Voice colouring may be characterized as unemotional, dispassionate, Terminal tones are usually final and categoric, falls prevail. Falling-ris­
reserved, but very resolute and assured, a typical case of a newsreader's ing tones (or even Rise-Fall- Rises) are often heard in the initial short into­
"neutral position", deliberately underlying the effect of objectiveness on nation groups introduced to draw the listener's attention:
the part of the newsreader.
A "'number of'/orry drivers and vmotorists I to l!1!1l 'YJ2 in time...
Loudness ranges from normal to forte; it is especially varied at passage
boundaries. With "'both 'carriageways vblocked Ipolice 'closed the motorwayfor a ,time... II
Levels and ranges are usually normal, but contrasted when each news
item is introduced and also at the semantic emphatic centres. Table J I
Pauses tend to be rather long, especially when they occur between pas­ Prosodic Characteristics of a News Bulletin Reading
sages, longer still between the bulletin items. The location ofpauses is com­ (Press Reporting and Broadcasting)
monly predictable, syntactically or semantically determined. r'" ---------------

Rate is not remarkably varied. It is normally slow, rarely allegro: delib­ \bice colouring dispassionate, impartial, but resolute and as­
erately slow (lento) on communicatively important centres. sured; the effect of "chilly distant sounding"
Rhythm exhibits a stable pattern. (usually achieved by special training ofthe an­
Types of heads vary, the most common being descending (falling and nouncers)
stepping), very often broken by accidental rises. Delimitation phonopassages - phrases - intonation groups
Another very common phenomenon is the variation of descending and Style- Loudness normal or increased, contrasted at the pho­
ascending heads of different levels to convey the information in a really in­ marking nopassage boundaries
teresting way, especially in the enumeration of the events: prosodic Levels and normal; decrease towards the end of the pas­
-+ Lane,discipline I was -+much worse in this ,country I than in A'merica II features ranges sage; noticeable increase at the start of any
and the "'habits of'drivers when 'overtaking I were par'ticularly bad. II ,One 'saw new news item
tjar too much 'dangerous "pulling out I without an -+adequate >signai \ having Rate not remarkably varied; slow, rarely allegro; de­
been .,given. liberately slow (lento) on communicatively
Also the semantic centre of the preceding intonation group may be re­ important centres
peated at the beginning of the next utterance. Lexically it may be the same Pauses rather long, especially at the end of each news
word or word combination or a related one. This is done to chain the item
es tightly into a phonetic whole (phonopassage). On the prosodic Rhythm stable, properly organized
136 Chapter V. Phonostylistics 5.3. Stylistic Use ofIntonation 137

Table 11 (Continued) 5.3.3. Academic style


Accen­ Tenninal frequent use of final, categoric falling tones on This phonetic style is often described as both intellectual and volitional.
tuation of tones the semantic centres and falling-rising or ris­
The speaker's aim is to get the information across to the listener, to educate,
semantic
ones in the initial intonation groups
to instruct. It is frequently manifested in lectures, scientific discussions, at
centres
Pre-nuclear common use of descending heads (very often conferences, seminars and in classes.
patterns broken); alternation of descending and as­ It can be suggested here that the most pure manifestation of the aca­
cerlolIlg heads demic phonetic style is realized in a lecture. Admittedly, there can be differ­
!------_t_
ent types of lectures, they vary in the degree of formality, the competence
The contrast not great

between the
and the individual manner of the lecturer and so on.
accented and
No public lecture is ever spontaneous, since all of them, even those in
unaccented
which no notes are used, will have been to some extent prepared in advance
and therefore represent the written variety of the language read aloud.
Here is an example of a carefully prepared lecture read aloud in public
Comparing phonostylistic characteristics of the reading of an infor­ addressed to a fairly-sized audience.
mational text and a news bulletin we can make the following observa­ You will "'all have 'seen from the 'handouts I which you have in vfront of
tions: you I that 01 pro"'pose to di'vide this 'course of v lectures I on the 'urban and
1. News bulletin read aloud conveys mainly factual infonnation, attitudi­ 'architectural de'velopment of, London I into "'three 'main ,sections, II and per>
nal function of intonation is of secondary importance here. -haps I I could 'Just point 'out, 'right at the he.,ginning, I that there will be a
"'good 'deal of 'overlap be.tween them. II T.hey are in-+tended to >stand I as
2. The prosodic parameters are not greatly varied in both registers of the
,separate, I -+self-contained ,units. 111'deed, \ I would 'go as far as to >say I that
style except for such occasions in news bulletins when pitch levels,
'anyone \ who "'tried to 'deal entirely 'senaratelv with the ,past, I the ,present, I
types of heads and pauses are alternated to break the monotony of
and the ""course ofdevelopment in the yfuture, I would be 'misrepre'senting the
speech and draw the listeners' or viewers' attention to something very
'way in which 'urban 'growth takes ,place. II
important in the message. This often happens when events are enu­
Now by -+way ofintro,duction, I I'd "'like to 'try and 'give some indi>cation
merated. Marked prosodic variations are also observed at the be­
of"'how 'London it'selfQ,riginated; II of""what de'velopmental 'treI:lds. were built
ginning and the end of each new paragraph or topic.
,into ,it, as it ,were, \from the -+very ,outset; I and of how -+these >trends have
3. Voice quality is a very important marker of news coverage reading. It is -+ affected its ,growth. II
very easily identified, often labelled as "distant", "indifferent", "im­ It -+started, of,course, I not as vD11£, but as cities. II The, Ramans built
partial", "neutral". It is true, of course, for events of routine charac­ a "'bridge a'cross the >Thames I at a "point where the 'estuary was 'narrow
ter. When tragic events are broadcast, for instance, all the prosodic g'nough to "make this a practical'propo,sition; \ and the en-+campment as.,saci­
features are changed to convey the meaning. a1£d with this obridge I"'grew 'up on the 'north 'bank ofthe ,river.
4. In the "news bulletin reading" the use ofbroken descending heads and The -+principal Jim ofthis enr-ampment Iwas "'on the 'site now 'occupied by the
fall-rises on initial intonation groups is more common. , Tower. 111-+ Further to the vwest, at a "point where the 'river was ~fordable, I flf.L '~
5. Pauses tend to be longer, the general tempo is faster than in the reading - Ithe -+Abbey of, Westminster - Iwas ,founded, Iand the "'two 'towns 'grew 'up oSide
of informational educational texts. by ,side -I ""one centred on the vilomaJ:l camp, Iand the -+otheron the ,Abbey.
6. The "broadcast" reading is more properly rhythmically organized. -+Now in my ,next ,lecture I I "hope to 'demonstrate in Vdetaill that "'this
Highly skilled newsreaders are capable of making the meaning clear 'state ofgf'fairs I this double vfocus, I as we might ,call it - I was of"'crucial
by careful control of rhythm. importance for the 'subsequent 'growth o!,London as a '@'
138 Chapter V. Phonostylistics 5.3. Stylistic Use ofIntonation 139

This is a public lecture about the growth and development of London Table 12 (Continued)
addressed to a fairly-sized audience. The lecturer is evidently a specialist,
therefore he sounds very self-assured and comfortable with the subject, -~~ ses rather long, especially between the phonopassages; a
knowledgeable about the topic. The purpose of the lecturer is to deliver the large proportion ofpauses serving to bring out com­
municatively important parts of utteranccs; occasion­
message across to the audience. To implement this goal he tries to engage al use of breath-taking pauses
the attention and interest of the listeners, to maintain contact.
Rhythm properly organized, especially while giving the rules,
The speaker uses all sorts of rhetorical strategies to involve the audience
the laws, drawing conclusions, etc.
and to implement his objectives:
Accen­ I Tel: minal high proportion of compound terminal tones (High
1'd like you to consider what happened as the two towns began to expand.
tuation of Iton es Fall + Low Rise; Fall-Rise, Rise-Fall-Rise); a grcat
semantic number of high categoric falls
What do you think the main consequences ofthe expansion were?
Icentn,,_
Pre -nuclear frequent use of stepping and falling heads; alternation
The speaker outlines the points he is going to lecture about, uses all sorts pat terns of descending and ascending heads, especially in enu­
of phrases to cla.ri1Y his position and underline each new item in the text: merations
Th ~ contrast not great
You will all have seenfrom the handouts which you have infront ofyou that bet "een the
I propose to divide this course oflectures on the urban and architectural devel­ ace ented and
opment ofLondon into three main sections and perhaps I could just point out, un :ccented
right at the beginning that there will be a good deal ofoverlap between them. seg nents
Indeed l wouldgo asfar as to say. ..
Now by way ofintroduction Iid like to try and give some indication of.. Now we would like to give an outline of the specific characteristics of
Now in my next lecture Ihope to demonstrate in detail. .. the academic style presentation:
1. Academic presentations are generally well prepared and even rehearsed
The relationship between the lecturer and the audience is on the whole by a trained lecturer.
rather formal. At the same time he sounds interested, involved, enthusiastic 2. The lecturer sounds self-assured, authoritative, instructive and edify­
about the subject of his talk. ing.
3. The degree ofloudness is determined by the size of the audience.
Table 12
4. The prosodic features of the academic style presentation are varied. We
Prosodic Characteristics of Academic Style Presentation
can observe marked variations of terminal tones, pre-nuclear patterns,
Voice colouring "11ft ranges, tempo and loudness.
ve, lIltpV:S11ll:\, edifying, instructive,
self-assured 5. The rhythmical organization of the text is properly balanced by the al­
Delimitation phonopassages - phrases
ternation of all prosodic features which gives the acoustic impression of
intonation groups
Style-mark-
"rhythmicality" .
Loudness increased, sometimes to forte
ing prosodic 6. High falling and falling-rising terminal tones are widely used as a means
Levels and remarkably varied within the passage; gradual de- of both logical and contrastive emphasis.
features
ranges crease within the supraphrasal unit We have described common prosodic features which can be viewed as
Rate normal, slow in the most important parts ofthe lec­ markers of academic style. It should be mentioned that today academic
ture (rules, conclusions, examples); rate is as flexible presentations vary considerably depending on the following factors: the
as the lecturer wishes it to be
topic, the number oflisteners, their qualitative charactersistics (ethnic, so­
140 Chapter V Phonostylistics 5.3. Stylistic Use oflntonation 141

cial, cultural, cognitive, psychological), character of speaker/audience re­ On the other hand, the proper response ofthe audience inspires the speaker
lationship (formal/informal), method of delivery, individual manner of the and stimulates him for an ever more successful talk.
lecturer. All these factors determine the prosodic realization of each par­ One would always expect a political and judicial speech to be given in a
ticular public presentation. forceful and lively manner because the effects offailing to be convincing is
likely to be severe for speakers, politicians and judges especially. These
5.3.4. Publicistic style speeches are easily identified due to a set ofspecific grammar constructions,
lexical means and intonation patterns.
The term "publicistic" serves for many kinds of rhetorical activities, These features are absolutely predictable because they are markers of this
that is why this phonetic style is often called "oratorial". It is a very broad style. For example, a very notable and common stylistic feature used here is
notion because there is a great deal ofoverlap between academic, publicistic parallelism - the repetition ofsyntactical, lexical and prosodic structures.
and declamatory style when the basic aim of the speaker is persuasion. But Basically political speeches, addresses of Governments tend to be very
in publicistic speeches it is achieved not only through argumentation as in formal, so a great number of "high-flown" phrases, set expressions are com­
the academic style or imagery as in the declamatory style, but through a mon to this style as is seen from an imaginary political speech taken as a
combination of rhetorical strategies. model from the Advanced English Course:
This is especially noticeable in public political speeches of some politi­
cians whose appeals to the nation are overloaded with all sorts of oratorial The '>I.time has 'almost 'come, 'ladies and ,gentlemen, I when the '>I.Gov­
tricks and characterized by various contrasts in all prosodic features to pro­ ernment must 'ask 'YOU II the e'>l.lectors of'Great ,Britain I to re-+new, its
duce a complex vocal effect, thus making the presentations more effective. ,mandate. It is as a -+member ofthe ,Government I that I'>I.stand be'fore you this
Publicistic style is manifested in political, judicial, oratorial speeches, ,evening. I and the '>I.task I have 'set ll1J:,~1 is to re'>l.view 'many >things I which
in sermons, parliamentary debates, at congresses, meetings, press confer­ the -+Government has (L,chieved I since the '>I.lasf 'General Ejection I and to
ences and so on. -+outline the ,path I which we '>I.hope to 'follow in the future, ,when, I as I am
It has long been believed that public speaking is an art and rhetorical -+confident will be the ,case, I you re-+turn us to ,office I with an even "greater
skills need special training. It is evident, of course, that intonation has al­ 'parliamentary maJority.
ways been of primary importance there and surely needed accurate training -+ No one will deny I that ~hat we have been 'able to 'do in the 'past 'five
and exaggeration to achieve excessive emotional colouring. The use of pro­ ,vears I is es-+pecially ,striking in -+view ofthe I which we in'>I.herited from
sodic contrasts makes the speaker sometimes go to extremes and become the 'previous ,Government. With '>I.wages and 'prices 'spiralling, upwards; I with a
needlessly dramatic. '>I.record 'trade >deficit Iorhundretis ofmillions of,pounds, I and with the -+pound
Another important feature of publicistic style speeches is that they are >sterling IaFflicted by the evapo'ration ofinternational >confidence the '>I.coun­
never spontaneous. It is generally accepted that any professional talk is a try was 'then on the tbrink offi'nancial di,saster I and eco'nomic coUapse...
"voyage", and it should be charted, but it is strongly advisable not to use
notes during the speech performance because they might destroy contact It should be noted here, however, that in some public speeches there
with the listeners. A public speech is generally written and rehearsed before­ may be deviations from formality and a contrast is often to be seen between
hand, however, the speaker tries to create the effect of spontaneity and to the highly formal and rather ordinary and in some instances even colloquial
avoid the impression ofcomplete preparedness, which contributes to effec­ language, when various illustrations, examples, comparisons, jokes, quota­
tive interaction with the audience. tions are produced. So a good speaker is aware of a proper balance between
As was stated above, the purpose of oratorial performances is to stimu­ intelligibility, formality and informality.
late, inspire the listeners, to arouse enthusiasm in them; so the kinesic ac­ Having outlined briefly the spheres ofthe publicistic style manifestation
companiment - facial expressions, bodily movements, gestures - is ex­ we would like to concentrate now on the phonostylistic characteristics of a
tremely important and helps to achieve the task, to put heart into the talking. publicistic speech (Table 13).
142 Chapter V. Phonostylistics 5.3. Stylistic Use ofIntonation 143

On the prosodic level public monologues are characterized by marked Table 13 (Continued)
variations and contrasts within the systems of pitch, loudness, tempo and
Accentua- Pre-nudear common 0: e of the descending sequence of stressed syl­
timbre accompanied by kinesic components.
tion of patterns lables; alaI proportion of falling and stepping
These prosodic contrast'>, very expressive facial mimics and gestures semantic frequently I roken by accidental rises to increa.'IC the em­
identify certain oral texts as belonging to publicistic phonetic style. centres phasis; ano her common "rhetorical trick" is the tonal
Table 13 subordinatl on when semantically and communicatively
important j ntonation groups contrast with their sur-
Model Intonation Characteristics of Publicistic Oratorial Speech roundings j n all prosodic features; so the high level head
maybe alte nated with the low level head, especially in
Voice colouring dignified, self-assured, concerned and personally in­ enumeratic ns
volved; a variety of attitudinal and modal expressions in
the voice The con- not great
trast be-
Delimitation phonopassages - phrases - intonation groups tweenac-
Style- Loudness enormously increased, ranging from forte to fortissimo; cented and
marking sometimes instances of diminished loudness are observed unaccented
prosodic to bring out words and phrases ofparamount importance segments
features and produce certain psychological effect Paralinguis- agreatnurr ber ofparalinguistic effects, kinesic compo­
Ranges and varied; the predominant use ofwide ranges within tic features nents - fac al expressions, bodily movements, gestures
levels the phonopassage; a very high level of the start ofthe ini­ subjected t( the main purpose of the pubJicistic discourse:
tial intonation groups to influenc( the audience, involve it into the talk and to
Rate exert the expected response from it
moderately slow; the public :,peaker slows down to bring ------

out communicatively important centres; less important


information entails acceleration of speed As any public ·speech is fully prepared and even rehearsed, it usually
Pauses definitely long between the passages; a great number of goes smoothly and with ease, without hesitation devices. It is marked by its
breath-taking pauses; pausation is commonly explicable dignified slowness, careful articulation and impressive resonance on the
in semantic and syntactic terms; interpausal segments are most important communicative centres and properly rhythmically orga­
rather short, thus phrases may be overloaded by pauses of
different length; another characteristic feature ofthis reg­
nized. Of course, it is not always uniformly so. Occasionally a speaker may
ister is a rather frequent stop ofphonation before the em­ drift from the register and sound less formal or even chatty or needlessly
phatic semantic centre; it serves as a means of bringing dramatic. On such occasions the speaker tries to entertain the public and
out words and phrases; voiceless hesitation pauses occur the speech is characterized by markers of declamatory, academic, informa­
to produce the effect of apparent spontaneity, "rhetorical tional or conversational styles. There are speakers who usualJy vary the reg­
silence" is often used to exert influence on the public
isters to achieve greater effectiveness.
Rhythm properly organized; within the speech segments rhythmic The speakers are usually very enthusiastic about what they say, so they
groups have recurrent alternation, which produces the may go to extremes by enormously increasing the loudness and alternate it
acoustic effect ofstrict rhythmicaJity
whisper or by pronouncing very long breath groups and suddenly in­
Aceentua­ Terminal mostly emphatic, especially on emotionally underlined terrupt the phonation by using the rhetorical silence. These and other pro­
tion of tones semantic centres; in non-final intonational groups fall­
semantic
sodic contrasts produce great effects and captivate the attention and interest
ing-rising tones are frequent; terminal tones are contrast-
centres cd to distinguish between the formal segments of speech ofthe listener.
and less formal ones (illustrations, examples, jokes, and A characteristic feature of publicistic style presentations is a large
soon) amount of parallelisms on any level, prosodic features including.
144 Chapter V. Phonostyiistics 5.3. Stylistic Use ofIntonation 145

All the above-mentioned general characteristics serve to produce a com­ tions between the ways of reading: "The reader has two entirely different
plex vocal effect called "oration", designed to make the speech effective. options: he can either enter into the text, interpret it and "perform" it as if
We have tried to describe here only one register of the style. There are he himself were speaking to the listener, saying as it were "this is what the
certainly other spheres of discourse - spontaneous speeches at the meet­ text means"; or he can stand outside the text and simply act as the medium,
ings, debates, after dinner speeches, speeches at anniversaries, prize-giving saying that is what the text says" (D. Brazil 1980: 83). Artistic reading is
Speeches and so on. They will certainly differ greatly on the prosodic level, defmitelya skilled activity that can be judged by aesthetic criteria.
but the volitional function of intonation, expressed by the contrast of all Intonation properties ofthe text read out loud depend on the type
prosodic parameters, will always be in the foreground and mark the publi­ written text.
cistic style. It is common knowledge that prose, which describes an action or a se­
ries ofactions to tell a story, is called narrative:
5.3.5. Declamatory style. Artistic reading
Though it was nearly midnight when Andrew reached Bryngower, he found
This phonetic style is also called artistic or stage. It is a highlyemotion­ Joe Morgan waitingfor him, walking up and down with short steps between the
al and expressive style, which needs special training. This phonetic style is closed surgery and the entrance to the house.
used on the stage, in films or in prose and poetry recitations. Thus we see (A. J. Cronin. The Citadel)
that it is always a written form of the language read aloud or recited.
It is a very difficult task to give a detailed description ofthe The prose is descriptive when scenes, objects, people, or even a person's
in this book as it is the stylization ofall speech styles, especially conversation­ feelings are described in such a way that we can imagine them vividly. In
al. Conversations on the stage are generally meant to reflect natural speech good descriptive writing an author builds up a picture in words in much the
interaction, but, addressed to the spectators, they produce an exaggerated same way as an artist paints a landscape or a portrait:
effect: due to such prosodic parameters as loudness, rate and range that are
immediately identified by listeners as "stage speech" characteristics. We got out at Sonning and went for a walk round the village. It is a most
The prosodic organization of such texts will vary greatly, depending on fairy-like little nook on the whole river. It is most like a stage village that one
the type of the theatrical performance - whether it is a tragedy, drama or builds of bricks and mortar. Every house is smothered in roses and now, in
comedy, the style of the author, and, of course, on the social factors the early June, they were burstingforth in clouds ofdainty splendour. ..
social and cultural background of the play characters, their relationships, (Jerome K Jerome. Three Men in a Boat)
extralinguistic context, and so on.
Acting is a two-way conversation, players respond to the "feedback"
In order to appreciate a prose passage it is not enough to understand its
they from the audience; the "feedback" in their case being almost cer­ meaning: it is necessary to grasp the author's intentions and the artistic
non-verbal language. Methods of achieving,
means he uses.
1<1111l<.tlllllJ.g this "conversation" with their audience are an
It is necessary, ofcourse, before reading aloud to appreciate the written text.
actors' training. Distancing, posture, gesture, facial For this one should firstly read the passage carefully. Then, while reading it a
expression and timing - all these facets of their art are as important as the second time, pay close attention to the sequence of events described or to the
delivery ofwords themselves. stages, which 1ead to the main event. See if the writer gives reasons why the
Since declamatory style is a vast area for investigation and description event or events described occurred. When you have read a prose passage care­
we would like here to restrict our analysis to the register needed in class for fully you should consider the following aspects: general meaning, detailed
training would-be teachers of English: prose reading and poetry recitation. meaning and the intentions ofthe writer and stylistic devices used in the text.
It should be noted that the recitation of prose and poetry has always What makes a story a pleasure to read is usually the writer's way
been regarded as an art. According to D. Brazil there are marked distinc­ ing it. The way scenes and people are described, the way the characters
T
~
'I'
"t:
,,
'4' I

146 Chapter V. Phonostylistics 5.3. Stylistic Use ofIntonation 147

think, talk or act are as important as the events themselves and contribute "You go up to bed," I said, "you're sick."
largely to our enjoyment. When appreciating a piece of prose it is necessary "I'm all right, " he said.
to understand how these qualities or devices help a story to develop and how When the doctor came he took the boy's temperature.
they add colour to it. (E. Hemingway. A Day's Wait)
One should also bear in mind that any story is a unity, though divided
into passages. It is very important to understand how pieces of narrative are The conversations are strikingly different in style and for their charac­
put together. A reader responds to a text, its linguistic clues (internal evi­ teristics see corresponding sections of the chapter. We must mention here,
dence), but also to situational clues (external evidence). In responding to a however, that most literary texts comprise descriptions, narrations and dia­
text the reader usually takes into account all he/she knows of the environ­ logues.
ment: what is going on, who is involved as well as what part the language The experimental data of the research works on the artistic reading al­
plays. low us to say that its prosodic organization depends on the type of the liter­
Evidently the next step will be to break the text into phonopassages that ary text - descriptive, narrative, dialogue; on the character of the described
may not coincide with the written passages. Then the passage should be split events, schemes and objects (humorous, tragic, romantic, dreamy, imagi­
into phrases, the latter into intonation groups. The most necessary proce­ native and so on) and of course on the skills of the reader. But it is always
dure, of course, is to underline the communicative centres in each intona­ clearly marked by its expressiveness, personal involvement on the part ofthe
tion group and choose the prosodic features which will be appropriate and author, emphasis, by the entire range of prosodic and paralinguistic effects
will effectively express the meaning. and it is all felt through skilful reading (see Table 14).
A writer helps his characters to come alive not only by describing the Table 14
way they act but also by letting us hear them speak. Thus narrative or de­ Model Intonation Characteristics of the Declamatory Prose Reading
scriptive prose can be interrupted by dialogue. Effective dialogue enables
the reader to feel that he is actually witnessing what is going on. Voice colouring concerned, personally involved, emotionally rich
Dialogues are author's reproduction ofactual conversation and in read­ Delimitation phonopassages - phrases - intonaton groups
ing aloud a reader should bear in mind the characters of the speakers, their Style-mark­ Loudness varied according to the size ofthe audience and to the
social background and the atmosphere, the environment, in which the con­ ing prosodic emotional setting
versation takes place. features Levels and variable
The author sometimes provides us with clues as to how the speech ofthe ranges
characters should be interpreted: Rate deliberately slow, necessitated by the purpose of the
reading: the complete understanding of the author's
He came into the room to shut the windows while we were still in bed and I message by the listener; changes in the speed of utter­
saw he looked ill. He was shivering, hisface was white, and he walked slowly as ances are determined by the syntactic structures, impor­
tance of information and the degree of emphasis
though it ached to move.
"What's the matter, Schatz?" Pauses long, especially between the passages. Disjunctive paus­
es tend to be longer than connecting ones. Internal
"I've got a headache. "
boundary placement is always syntactically or semanti­
"You'd better go back to bed." cally predictable. A declamatory reading is distinctly
"No, I'm all right. " marked by a great number of prolonged emphatic paus­
"You go to bed. I'll see you when I'm dressed. " es ­ the device used by the reader to underline the em­
But when I came downstairs he was dressed, sitting by the fire, looking a phasis
very sick and miserable boy ofnine years. When I put my hand on hisforehead Rhythm properly organized, the isochronic recurrence of
I knew he had a fever. stressed and unstressed syllables
148 Chapter V. Phonostylistics 5.3. Stylistic Use ofTntonation 149

Table 14 (Continued) ers. So it is generally called conversational. Some scholars also call it
Accen­ Terminal common use of categoric low and high fails in final and informal, because this style occurs mainly in informal external and
tuation of tones even initial intonation groups and on semantic centres; internal relationships in the speech ofrelatives, friends and the like.
semantic occasional use of rising and level tones to break the mo­ In informal situations, where speakers are more relaxed, less attention
centres notonyand in initial groups to connect segments ofthe is given to the effect they produce on the listeners, because, as it has al­
phrase I
ready been mentioned, in formal situations they monitor their linguistic
Pre-nucle­ varied, contain patterns which have both common em- behaviour, perhaps sometimes unconsciously. But in life a more
arpatterns phatic and non -emphatic usage; for the emphasis the natural and spontaneous style will be used. It is the style at the extreme
following patterns are most frequently used: Low Head informal end of the stylistic linear continuum that is known as "vernacu­
+ High Fall, High Head + Low Fall, High Head +
High Fal, Stepping Head + High Fall
lar". Thus all speakers have a vernacular style but its variations in the use
of non-standard norms depend on the social background. In this style
The con­ not great
variation will be at its most consistent leveL It is the most situationally in­
trast be­
tween ac­ fluenced kind of English. From pedagogical viewpoint this English seems
cented and to be one of the most useful and least artificial kinds of the language to
unaccented teach foreign learners.
segments We would also point out here that in conversational style the emo­
reaction to the stimulating speech signals is very important so the
On the prosodic level the markers ofthe declamatory style reading are: lllluuinal function ofintonation here comes to the fore. Therefore one is
1. Slow tempo, caused by the lento rate ofutterances and prolonged paus­ to find here a wider range ofcontrasts at any level than could be ex­
es, especially at the passage boundaries. pected elsewhere .. We have already outlined specifications of different
2. Stable rhythmicality. types of dialogues, classified them according to the degree offormality, so
3. The use of the falling terminal tones in initial intonation groups, the here we will attempt to gain some insight into everyday conversations.
increase oftheir range with the emphasis. Conversations are one of the most complex forms of human behav­
Now by way of conclusion we would like to say that we have made an iour. When one starts to examine in depth even apparently trivial conver­
attempt here to describe one type of the declamatory style reading, which sations, the complexity soon becomes obvious and, as with most other
may be valuable for teachers of English. Language teachers should pay a aspects of language study, new dimensions to the study appear.
great deal of attention to expressive declamatory reading as it helps students Clearly, a conversation consists of more than verbal language. Com­
to understand and appreciate literature, broadens their horizons. Artistic munication, to be effective, relies on other features than language and a
reading can show them the subtleties of the author's intention, unlock his great deal on what is not said. A measure of common understanding has to
secrets and pave the way to something new, something different. exist between speakers. Where this common understanding is lacking,
failures in communication are apt to occur.
5.3.6. Conversational style In a conversation we do not just listen to words, we derive the meaning
consciously or unconsciously from a number of other communicative sys­
aim of this section is to analyse variations that occur in natural tems and it could be that a lift of an eyebrow, a twitch of the mouth, or a
spontaneous, everyday speech. It is the most commonly used phonetic silence tell us more than a dozen sentences.
style and consequently a variety which will be more familiar to the vast But undoubtedly the verbal part of the communication plays a very
majority of English-speaking people than any other. That is why it is important role and has its own systems too but only linked with other ef­
called familiar. This kind of English is also a means for everyday com­ fective ways contributed by the speakers. The full effect is achieved
munication, heard in natural conversational interaction between speak­ meanings are exchanged even with strangers and about unfamiliar topics.
150 Chapter V. Phonostylistics 5.3. Stylistic Use ofIntonation 151

So to study conversational interactions means to study some of the Richard: Well, I'm going tonight in fact.
"rules" of non-verbal behaviour in relation to particular cultures and so­ Jane: Tonight?Oh, are you ?
cieties and also to study the linguistic rules governing the talks. Both types Richard: Yes, most nights really.
of study are still in relatively early infancy and the study ofthe relationship
between them is even less advanced.
Another complexity in carrying out research of this type of speech lies
in the procedural difficulties ofobtaining reliable data. It is well-known that
most people behave differently ifthey are aware ofbeing tape-recorded, but
unfortunately linguists cannot analyse everyday language without making
tape recordings first.
So of course the recorded samples of spontaneous mlormal conversa­
tions are not quite reliable. The only safe way of obtaining data is
the technique of "surreptitious" recording. However, the transcript ofthese
talks doesn't show non-verbal means of communication - postures, ges­
tures, facial expressions, manners and other superficial manifestations
which constitute the so-called "silent language" ofpeople. With the inven­
tion of "video" one can easily solve this problem and the fieldwork proce­
dures using it will be able to achieve quite realistic, objective data and inves­
tigate the phenomena in all its complexity and unity.
Unfortunately, in this book we rely only upon the tapescripts of every­
day informal conversations recorded for English textbooks.
Spontaneous, colloquial, informal conversations display certain com­
mon linguistic characteristics.
1. Firstly, talks ofthis kind are characterized by the inexplicitness ofthe
language as the speakers rely very much upon the extralinguistic factors ­
context, etc. This manifests itself in "incompleteness" of many
utterances as the context makes it clear what was meant by the speaker, thus
making redundant its vocal expression:
Jane: Well... maybe, but... take responsibility; the ... the ... you don't need
as great a sense ofresponsibility for you ... your kind ofwork as you
do in teaching - all those children, all those parents...
Brenda: No, but you do have your. .. your. .. your colleagues at work you
have a certain amount ofresponsibility to them.
Sometimes the speakers even abrupt the speech suddenly and
silence but the listeners understand them, catch the meaning, because the par­
ticipants have a common personal background and the explicitness is tolerated
or even taken for granted and is diagnostic of conversation. Occasionally, the
listeners request recapitulation by all sorts of repeated and echoing questions:
152 Chapter V. Phonostylistics 5.3. Stylistic Use of Intonation 153

conduct of conversation. Some of these tactics are verbal, others non-ver­ L.H6U.:>H are totally different varieties of the language and the criteria of
bal, most are culturally determined, some make individual use of cultural acceptable usage must not be confused.
habits and expectations. Together with the "silent language" (posture, ges­ The most noticeable aspect of everyday conversations is their vocabulary.
facial expression and manners) the space between the speakers also It is characterized by colloquial idioms, the use ofwords simple in structure,
plays an important part in communication. It is a measure of how intimate the avoidance of phraseology; also the informality of the text is achieved by
or otherwise the speakers feel, how formal or informal their relationship is. the use ofwords and phrases specific for such conversations, e. g. Yeah. Right.
A "nose-to-nose" distance of I metres is considered to be most OK. I see. Oh, yes. Yes, yes. Oh, lovely. Oh dear. Alright. Sure. Good heavens!
comfortable for talks and anything nearer than this may be unwelcome ifthe Thanks! Jolly good! Really? Come offit! Oh, no! Hey! and others.
other is not regarded as an intimate. Of course the "silent language" has
significance at deeper levels and in more complex ways than that exhibited On the prosodic level the field researchers provide us with data that
in gesture or postural language. There are more message systems but they us to do some generalizations:
are not fully investigated yet. 1. Conversations fall into coordinated blocks, consisting of supraseg­
On the grammatical level informal conversation provides delimitation mental and supraphrasal units tied up by variations within the length of
of utterances and sentences. The length ofutterances is much more variable pauses, speed, rhythm, pitch ranges, pitch levels and loudness.
here than in any other variety ofEnglish. There is also a problem ofdelimit­ 2. Since there are no restrictions on the range and depth of emotions
ing sentences from each other as our conversations are characterized by a which might be displayed in conversational speech situations they will allow
large number ofloosely coordinated clauses and it is very difficult to decide entire range of prosodic effects.
whether to take these as sequences or as compound sentences: 3. In the description ofprosodic characteristics ofthis phonetic style we will
begin by saying that intonation groups are rather short, their potentially lengthy
Jane: Well, ... maybe, but... take responsibility for your kind ofwork as you
tone units tend to be broken. These short interpausal units are characterized by
do in teaching - all those children, all those parents...
decentralized stress and sudden jumps down on communicative centres:
Minor sentences are extremely frequent in responses, many of them are
Jane: -"That's ,going... I to -"make you very un'fit, you know.
incomplete. There are a other points to be noted on the grammatical
level: 4. The heads are usually level, or rarely, falling. Falling heads occur only
1. High proportion of parenthetic compound types of sentence intro­ in groups consisting ofseveral stressed syllables.
duced by you see, you know, I mean, I say and others. 5. As for the nuclei, simple falling and rising tones are common. Em­
2. Frequent use of interrogative sentence types and very few imperatives. phatic tones occur in highly emotional contexts. High pre-nuclear syllables
3. Common use of vocatives, especially in initial position. are very frequent, e. g.
4. Rare use ofnominal groups as subjects; the personal pronouns are more in
«-Do you think it ,matters?"
evidence, the informal you is quite common in its impersonal function.
"- I'd -"rather be °thin than Jat."
5. A great number of question tags.
6. The use of all sorts of repetitions and repetition structures. Even adver­ 6. The tempo of colloquial speech is very varied. The natural speed
bial intensifiers such as very may be repeated several times. might be very fast but the impression of "slowness" may arise because of a
7. The occurrence of contrasted verbal forms (he's, I'll, I've). great number ofhesitation pauses both filled and non-filled (hesitant drawls)
8. The frequency ofcolloquial ellipses. within the block. However, the speakers may have no pauses between
All these features and many others, not mentioned here, would be con­ parts, very often they speak simultaneously, interrupt each other.
demned by many teachers of grammar and it would be only just for any Also a familiar point about informal conversation is the frequency of
other speech style, but for this type of speech it is a standard and indeed a silence for purposes of contrastive pause as opposed to its being required
valuable part ofinformal conversation. Formal written and informal spoken simply for breathtaking.
154 Chapter V. Phonostylistics 5.3. Stylistic Use ofIntonation 155

Pauses may occur randomly, not just at places ofgrammatical junctions, ofwords) is more frequent here than elsewhere. In view of the purpose of a
e. g. call questions (also repeated and echoed), responses and impera­
tives are very common.
Richard: ,Oh, you seem to I "'realize >that... III that I .like Vocabulary is characterized by the use ofcolloquialisms, idioms and vo­
it. calization. The opening and closing ofa telephone conversation are marked
by the use of the same formulas, the linguistic devices carrying out these
So, tempo is very flexible in this style. It is uneven with and between ut­ operations are not numerous and always predicted.
terances. It is obvious that telephone conversations differ from others mainly in
7. Interpausal stretches have a marked tendency towards subjective degree offormality and can most realistically be seen as a subprovince
rhythmic isochrony. more general notion.
Now to conclude the description of prosodic characteristics we would We shall conclude this chapter by examining one more area ofconver­
like to point out that the impression that the intonation is rather "chaotic" sations, namely, when partners' stretches of speech are not equal: one is
in conversations is completely wrong. Suprasegmental features form a basic an active speaker, the other is an active listener. It happens when people
set of recurrent patterns which is occasionally disturbed by the stories ofanecdotal character or in the form oflong narratives. It may
of specific prosodic and paralinguistic effects which depend upon the mo­ be the story of a film or a book or just a story of events that have happened
an individual is to us. In this case the speech of the narrator reminds us very much of the
Now we shall examine another, very specific register of conversational informational monologue, only differs in the degree offormality.
style - telephone conversations. This sphere of communication is limited Correspondingly, there is a greater variety in using hesitation phenom­
in certain important respects by the special situation, which imposes a num­ ena (filled or non-filled), vocalizations, repetitions and so on.
ber of restrictions. The speed of utterances and pausal contrasts vary in accordance
The conversationalists who can see each other are able to place a great the semantic value of the narration.
amount of reliance on the facilities otTered by such things as gesture and the The listener responds either non-verbally by using vocalizations, gestures
presence ofa common extralinguistic context. and facial expressions or by prompting the talk with aU sorts ofphrases show­
Telephone conversations lack these facilities to a large extent and so ing personal concerned interest, like: What then? So what? And? Well? and so
have a tendency to become more explicit than ordinary conversations on.
a different use of "indicator" words such as pronouns which may be vague Now by way ofconclusion we would like to say that it is not without sig­
in their reference ifit cannot be seen who or what is referred to. nificance that education is now increasingly interested in communicative
The telephone situation is quite unique being the only frequently oc­ studies. Teachers have to find new ways of coming to terms with those they
curring case of a conversation in which the participants are not visible to hope to teach and the study ofinteraction is one way oftrying to enable suf­
each other, so there is some uncertainty in keeping up the give-and-take ficient "conversation" to take place to facilitate teaching and learning.
between the participants. In a study of interaction there is a real hope for improving teacher's ef­
A different range of situational pressures is exerted upon the partici­ fectiveness. Hut any such study has to be highly complex, and in view of the
pants, and consequently a range of linguistic contrasts which they are per­ difficulty and complexity the question ofwhether such studies can be ofprac­
mitted to choose differs somewhat. tical value was raised and some useful advice for such attempts was given.
The participants avoid long utterances without introducing pauses. "Language" and "People" are both familiar terms and represent famil­
Pauses cannot be long, because anything approaching a silence may be in­ iar things. Hut the "and" between them represents an enormously complex
terpreted by the listener either as a breakdown of communication or as an relationship. This relationship involves cultures and civilizations, individual
for interruption which may not have been desired. \biced hesi­ human beings, their interaction and their forms of organization, it involves
the gap (drawls, random vocalizations, repetitions values.
156 Chapter V. Phonostylistics Summary 157

Our book cannot pretend to explore in any depth or with any adequacy The classification ofphonetic styles is based on the purpose of commu­
such vast areas, but it seems worth making attempts to trail some of the nication, which is the most significant extralinguistic factor. Five phonetic
more significant strands in the relationships and that's what we tried to do styles can be singled out according to the purpose of communication:
here. 1. Informational style;
2. Academic (Scientific) style;
3. Publicistic (Oratorial) style;
Summary 4. Declamatory (Artistic) style;
5. Conversational (Familiar) style.
When used in speech phonetic units undergo various changes under the Stylistic variations of sounds and intonation result from different com­
influence of extralinguistic factors. The bundle of these factors forms the binations of extralinguistic factors. Stylistic modifications of sounds are
extralinguistic situation. The extralinguistic situation determines the choice caused primarily by the degree of formality, while variations of intonation
oflanguage means, phonetic means in particular. are basically determined by the aim of communication.
Phonostylistics is a branch ofphonetics which studies the way phonetic In formal situations pronunciation tends to be careful and is character­
units (both segmental and suprasegmental) are used in particular extralin­ ized by articulatory precision. In informal situations speech is generally
guistic situations. faster and less careful. In informal casual discourse (fast colloquial speech)
The extralinguistic situation can be described in terms of three compo­ the processes of simplification take place: assimilation, reduction, elision.
nents, i. e. purpose, participants and setting. These components distinguish Each of the five phonetic styles is used in a particular sphere of dis­
situations as the context in which speech interaction takes place. course and is characterized by a set of prosodic features, which in their
Purpose is the most important factor that guides the communication. It combination form the model of the phonetic style.
is the task that is achieved in the course of communication. Participants are
people involved in communication. Speech is a marker of various charac­
teristics of people, both individual and social: age, gender, family back­
ground, occupation, social roles. The scene (setting) includes the physical
orientation of participants, which is connected with the type of speech ac­
tivity they are engaged in. Scenes can also be described in the following
tenus: public - non-public (private), formal informal, monologuing
dialoguing - poliloguing. The channel ofcommunication is also to be taken
into consideration: face-to-face interaction telephone communication,
mass media communication.
The extralinguistic factors, that determine the choice ofphonetic means
and result in phonostylistic variation are:
the purpose, or aim ofcommunication;
the degree of formality ofthe situation;
the degree of spontaneity;
speaker's attitude.
The purpose, or aim ofcommunication may be called a style forming fac­
tor, while all the others cause modifications within a particular style, which
account for the existence of different kinds and genres of texts within each
phonetic style. All the factors are interdependent and interconnected.
Chapter VI 6.1. Social Phonetics and Dialectology 159

Though in the past thirty years sociolinguistics has come of age and is a
SOCIAL AND TERRITORIAL VARIETIES fast expanding and increasingly popular subject it should be fair to mention
OF ENGLISH here that language is indissolubly linked with the society; in it we can see a
faithful reflection of the society in which people live.
It is quite clear, of course, that such fields of science as linguistics, so­
6.1. Social Phonetics and Dialectology ciolinguistics, psycholinguistics are inseparably linked in the treatment of
various language structures. For example, the subject matter of ethnolin­
6.2. Spread of English guistics gradually merges into that of anthropological linguistics, sociolin­
6.3. English-based Pronunciation Standards of guistics, stylistics and social psychology.
English Some scholars consider functional stylistics to be a branch of sociolinguis­
tics since it studies the distinctive linguistic characteristics of smaller social
6.3.1. British English groupings (such as those due to occupational class, age and sex differences).
6.3.2. Received pronunciation In the case of English there exists a great diversity in the spoken realiza­
6.3.3. Changes in the standard tion of the language and particularly in terms of pronunciation. The variet­
6.3.4. Regional non-RP accents of England ies of the language are conditioned by language communities ranging from
6.3.5. Welsh English small groups to nations. Now speaking about the nations we refer to the na­
6.3.6. Scottish English
tiona variants of the language. In their treatment we follow the conception
6.3.7. Northern Ireland English
of A. D. Shweitzer. According to him national language is a historical cat­
6.4. American-based Pronunciation Standards egory evolving from conditions of economic and political concentration
of English which characterizes the formation of a nation. In other words national lan­
guage is the language of a nation, the standard of its form, the language of a
6.4.1. General American
nation's literature.
It is common knowledge that language exists in two forms: written and
spoken. Any manifestation of language by means of speech is the result of a
6.1. Social Phonetics and Dialectology highly complicated series of events. The literary spoken form has its na­
tional pronunciation standard. A ."standard" may be defined as "a socially
This chapter is concerned with varieties of English in different countries accepted variety of a language established by a codified norm of correct­
of the world and geographical areas of Britain and also their social function ness" (Macaulay, 1977: 68).
in the society. Today all the English-speaking nations have their own national variants
It is a well-known fact that territorial Englishes are studied by dialec­ of pronunciation and each of them has peculiar features that distinguish it
tologists. from other varieties of English.
Dialectology, as a science, is inseparably connected with sociolinguis­ It is generally accepted that for the "English English" it is "Received
tics which deals with social variations caused by social differences and so­ Pronunciation" or RP; for "The American English" - "General American
cial needs; it studies the ways language interacts with the society. Sociolin­ pronunciation"; for the Australian English - "Educated Australian".
guistics is a branch of linguistics which studies aspects of the language Standard national pronunciation is sometimes called an "orthoepic norm".
(phonetics, lexis, grammar) with reference to their social functions in the Some phoneticians, however, prefer the term "literary pronunciation" .
society. So sociolinguistics explains the language phenomena in connection Though every national variant of English has considerable differences in
with factors outside the language itself in terms of large-scale social struc­ pronunciation, lexis and grammar, they all have much in common which gives
ture and in terms of how people use language in communication. us ground to speak of one and the same language - the English language.
160 Chapter VI. Social and Territorial Varieties 6.1. Social Phonetics and Dialectology 161

It would not be true to say that national standards are fIxed and immu­ Standard English is exerting an increasing powerful influence on the re­
They undergo constant changes due to various internal and external gional dialects of Great Britain. Recent surveys of British English dia­
Pronunciation, above all, subjects to all kinds ofinnovations. There­ lects have revealed that the pressure of Standard English is so strong that
fore the national variants of English differ primarily in sound, stress and many people are bilingual in a sense that they use an imitation of RP
intonation. It is well-known that there are countries with more than one with their teachers and lapse into their native local accent when speak­
national language, the most common case being the existence oftwo nation­ ing among themselves. In this occasion the term diglossia should be in­
al languages on the same territory. For this Canada will be an example, troduced to denote a state of linguistic duality in which the standard
where two different languages English and French - form the repertoire literary form of a language and one of its regional dialects are used by the
of the community. In this case scholars speak about bilingualism in contrast same individual in different social situations. This phenomenon should
to monolinguaIism typical of a country with one national language. Here not be mixed up with bilingualism that is the command of two different
arises the problem of interference, that is "linguistic disturbance which re­ languages. In the case of both diglossia and bilingualism the so-called
sults from two languages (or dialects), coming into contact in a specifIc sit­ code-switching takes place. In recent years the effect of these forms of
(Crystal, 1977: 254). linguistic behaviour is studied by sociolinguists and psychologists.
It may be well to state that every national variety of the language falls As was stated above, language, and especially its oral aspect varies with
into territorial or regional dialects. Dialects are distinguished from each respect to the social context in which it is used. The social differentiation
other by differences in pronunciation, grammar and vocabulary. We must of language is closely connected with the social differentiation of society.
make clear that, when we refer to varieties in pronunciation only, we use Nevertheless, linguistic facts cannot be attributed directly to class struc­
the word "accent". So local accents may have many features of pronun­ ture. According to A. D. Shweitzer "the impact of social factors on lan­
ciation in common and consequently are grouped into territorial or area guage is not confined to linguistic reflexes of class structure and should be
accents. In Britain, for example, Yorkshire, Lancashire and Cheshire ac­ examined with due regard for the meditating role of all class-derived ele­
cents form the group of "Northern accent". We must admit, however, that ments social groups, strata, occupational, cultural and other groups in­
in most textbooks on phonetics the word "dialect" is still used in reference cluding primary units (small groups)" (A. D. Shweitzer, 1983).
to the regional pronunciation peculiarities, though in the latest editions Western sociolinguists, such as A. D. Grimshaw, J. Z. Fisher,
both in this country and abroad the difference in terms "dialects and ac­ H. Bernstein, M. Gregory, S. Carroll, A. Hughes, P. Trudgill and others,
cents" is generally accepted. As we see, those terms should be treated dif­ are oriented towards small groups, viewing them as "microcosms" of the
ferently when related to different aspects of the language. It is, however, entire society.
true that there is a great deal of overlap between these terms. For certain Every language community, ranging from a small group to a nation
geographical, economic, political and cultural reasons one of the dialects has its own social dialect, and consequently, its own social accent.
becomes the standard language of the nation and its pronunciation or its British sociolinguists divide the society into the following classes:
accent - the received standard pronunciation. This was the case of London upper class, upper middle class, middle middle class, lower middle
dialect, which accent became the "RP" ("Received Pronunciation") of upper working class, middle working class, lower working class.
Britain. The validity of this classifIcation is being debated in sociolinguistics.
It has been estimated that the standard pronunciation of a country is The problem of social stratification and of group theory has only re­
not homogeneous. It changes in relation to other languages, and also to cently been tackled by the science of sociology. The serious study of so­
geographical, psychological, social and political influences. In England, for cial dialects must be proceeded, or at least accompanied by significant
example, we distinguish "conservative, general and advanced RP" (Gim­ advances in sociology and especially in the more precise definition of
son, 1981). the notions, such as class, nation, nationality, society, language commu­
As a result ofcertain social factors in the post-war period - the grow­ nity, occupation, social group, social setting, occupational group, and
ing urbanization, spread of education and the impact of mass media, so on.
---,­

162 Chapter VI. Social and Territorial Varieties of English 6.3. English-based Pronunciation Standards of English 163

It is well worth to understand that classes are split into different major speaking English as a mother tongue are Americans. Compared with it
and minor social groups (professional, educational, cultural, age, sex and so only 55 million speak English in Britain, therefore statistically you are
on). Correspondingly every social community has its own social dialect and much more likely to encounter American accents and dialects than Brit­
social accent. D. A. Shakhbagova defines social dialects as "varieties spoken ish ones.
by a socially limited number ofpeople" (Shakhbagova, 1982).
So in the light of social criteria languages are "characterized by two Figure 15
plans of socially conditioned variability - stratificational, linked with soci­ Vclrieties of English Pronunciation
etal structure, and situational, linked with the social context of language
I Varieties of English

--------
use" (A. D. Shweitzer, 1983: 6). I
Having had our main terms straightened we may speak now of the "lan­
guage situation" in terms of the horizontal and vertical differentiations of
the language, the first in accordance with the spheres of social activity, the
second - with its situational variability.
---------
English -based
pronunciation standards

American-based
pronunciation standards

It is evident that the language means are chosen consciously or subcon­


sciously by a speaker according to his perception of the situation, in which
--{ British English ) H
American English )

he finds himself. Hence situational varieties ofthe language are called func­ ( English English ----{ Canadian English )
tional dialects or functional styles and situational pronunciation varieties ­
situational accents or phonostyles. ( Welsh English
It has also to be remembered that the language ofits users varies accord­
ing to their individualities, range of intelligibility, cultural habits, gender ( Scottish English
and age differences. Individual speech of members of the same language
( Northern Ireland English
community is known as idiolect.
Now in conclusion it would be a perfectly natural thing to say that lan­
guage in serving personal and social needs becomes part ofthe ceaseless flux
--{ Irish English )

ofhuman life and activity. Human communication cannot be comprehend­ -{ Australian English )

ed without recognizing mutual dependence of language and context. The


mystery of language lies, if nowhere, in its endless ability to adapt both to Ii New Zealand English

the strategies of the individual and to the needs of the community, serving
each without imprisoning either. This is what makes sociolinguistics as a --{ South Mrica English )

science so important. In this book, though, we shall focus our attention on


territorial modifications of English pronunciation viewing them as an ob­
ject of sociolinguistic study. 6.3. English-based pronunciation standards of English

6.3.1. British English


6.2. Spread of English
As was mentioned before, BEPS (British English Pronunciation Stan­
The famous linguist D. Crystal estimates that roughly more than 400 dards and Accents) comprise English English, Welsh English, Scottish Eng­
million people speak English as a mother tongue around the world and of lish and Northern Ireland English (the corresponding abbreviations are EE,
those 400 million 226 of them live in the USA, thus 2 out of 3 people WE, ScE. , NIE).
164 Chapter VI. Social and Territorial Varieties of English 6.3. English-based Pronunciation Standards of English 165

Table 15 We can say that RP is a genuinely region less accent within Britain: you
British English Accents
cannot say which area of Britain the speakers of RP come from, which is not
English English Scottish English the case for any other type of British accents.
,----= ._­ f-.···-----··~I--------- .. -.
Welsh Northern It is fair to mention, however, that only 3-5% ofthe population of Eng­
Educated Ireland
Southern Northern English Regional land speak RP. According to British phoneticians (Ch. Barber, 1964;
Scottish English
varieties
-----
English A. Gimson, 1981; A. Hughes and P. Trudgill, 1980) RP is not homogeneous.
I. Southern 1. Northern A. Gimson suggests that it is convenient to distinguish three main types
1--------- -------- 1------ ----­
2. EastAnglia 2. Yorkshire within it: "the conservative RP forms, used by the older generation, and,
traditionally, by certain professions or social groups; the general RP forms,
3. South West 3. North-\\est
----- most commonly in use and typified by the pronunciation adopted by the
4. \\est Midlands BBC, and the advanced RP forms, mainly used by young people of exclu­
-------- '----------­ --------

sive social groups - mostly ofthe upper classes, but also for prestige value in
this chapter we are going to look in greater detail at the Received certain professional circles" (Gimson, 1981: 88).
Pronunciation (RP) and regional non-RP accents of England. Roughly In the last edition of ''An Introduction to the Pronunciation of English"
speaking the non- RP accents of England may be grouped like this: by A. C. Gimson, revised by Alan Cruttenden (2001) a new classification of
I. Southern accents: RP types is given:
1) Southern accents (Greater London, Cockney, Surray, Kent, Essex, General RP
Hertfordshire, Buckinghamshire); Refined RP
2) East Anglia accents (Lincolnshire, Norfolk, Suffolk, Cambridgeshire, Regional RP
Bedfordshire, Northamptonshire, Leicestershire); By "Regional RP" they mean standard pronunCiation norm in particu­
3) South-West accents (G10ucestershire, Avon, Somerset, WIltshire). geographical regions which are commonly close to the national RP but
reflect regional peCUliarities.
2. Northern and Midland accents:
Many native speakers, especially teachers of English, college and uni­
1) Northern accents (Northumberland, Durham);
versity professors (particularly in the South and South-East of England)
2) Yorkshire accents;
have accents closely resembling RP. P. Trudgill and J. Hannah call them
3) North-West accents (Lancashire, Cheshire);
Near-RP southern.
4) West Mjdland (Birmingham, Wolverhampton).
There is one regional type of RP which is widely discussed now under
the name "Estuary English" which is very close to "Advanced RP" or
6.3.2. Received Pronunciation "Near- RP accent".
It is often spoken by young people who want to avoid the "snobbish"
It has long been believed that RP is a social marker, a prestige accent of accent and at the same time to sound trendy and fashionable
an Englishman. In the nineteenth century "received" was understood in the Figure 16
sense of "accepted in the best society". The speech of the aristocracy and 'JYpes of English RP
the court phonetically was that of the London area. Then it lost its local (Received Pronunciation)
characteristics and was finally associated with ruling class accent, often re­
ferred to as "King's English". It was also the accent taught and spoken at National RP
public schools. WIth the spread of education cultured people not belonging
II other
to the upper classes were eager to modify their accent in the direction of
social standards.
refined, conservative
Oxford ~ng1ish.
King's ~nglish
general
mainstream.
BBC English
[:=000
Estuary English
near-RP
accent
RP
regional
accents
166 Chapter VI. Social and Territorial Varieties of English 6.3. English-based Pronunciation Standards of Eng1ish 167

6.3.3. Changes in the standard 2) There is a tendency for some ofthe existing diphthongs to be smoothed
out, to become shorter, so that they are more like pure vowels.
As was stated above, changes in the standard may be traced in the speech a) Thl" is very often the case with [el], particularly in the word final po­
of the younger generation of native RP speakers. These changes may affect where the glide is very slight: [ta'del], [seI], [mel].
all the features of articulation of vowel and consonant phonemes and also b) Diphthongs [aI], [au] are subject to a smoothing process where they
the prosodic system of the language. are followed by the neutral sound [a]:
Considerable changes are observed in the sound system of the present­ Conservative RP: [taua], [fala]
English, which are most remarkable since well-known Great Vowel General RP: [taa], [faa]
Shift in the Middle English period ofthe language development. It is a well­ Advanced RP: [ta:], [fa:]
established fact that no linguistic modification can occur all of a sudden. c) Also diphthongs [Ja], [ua] tend to be levelled to [J:]. Thus the pro­
The appearance of a new shade in the pronunciation of a sound results in nunciation of the words pore, poor is varied like this:
the coexistence of free variants in the realization of a phoneme. The choice older speakers:
between permissible variants of [w] or [A\] in wh-words is an illustration of middle-aged speakers:
what is meant by the process of variability and free variants. In Russian we younger speakers: [pJ:], [pJ:]
observe free variants of the pronunciation of the words of 9Hep2UJl, meMn It should be mentioned, however, that this tendency does not con­
type: non-palatalized and palatalized versions of [H] - [H'] and cern the diphthong [Ia] when it is final. The prominence and length
The degrees of variability are different. The most perceptible and stable shift to the glide, this final quality often being near to [A]: dear [dla] ­
changes are described in the works of British linguists and have been in­ [dIA].
vestigated by Russian phoneticians. The RP of recent years is characterized
by a greater amount ofpermissible variants compared to the "classical" type 2. According to the horizontal and vertical movement of the tongue
of RP described by D. Jones, L. Armstrong, I. Ward. Very striking changes occur in the vowel quality affected by the horizon­
The phenomenon is significant both from the theoretical and practical tal movement of the tongue. In fact the general tendency is marked by the
viewpoint. The variability concerns mainly vowels. Most of English vowels centering of both front and back vowels:
have undergone definite qualitative changes. The newly appeared variants the nuclei of [aI], [au] tend to be more back, especially in the male
exhibit different stability and range. ofthe pronunciation;
The qualitative distinctions manifest new allophonic realizations of the b) the vowel [ce] is often replaced by [a] by younger speakers: [hcev] ­
vowel phonemes. [hav], [cend] - [and];
c) the nucleus of the diphthong [3U] varies considerably ranging from
Changes in Vowel Quality [ou] among conservative speakers to [3U] and [au] among advanced
ones:
1. According to the stability of articulation Conservative RP:
1) It is generally acknowledged that two historically long vowels [i:], [u:] Advanced RP: __ _ _ _ __
have become diphthongized and are often called diphthongoids; the organs This tendency is so strong that the transcription symbol has been
of speech slightly change their articulation by the very end of pronuncia­ changed
tion, becoming more fronted. Ch. Barber tries to draw a parallel with the Back-advanced vowels [A], [u] are considerably fronted in advanced
Great Vowel Shift which took place in Middle English,
RP: but [bAt] - [bat], good [gud] [gad].
zation was just one part of a complete change of pattern in the long vowels.
There is a tendency for all short vowels to be produced nearer the cen­
He claims that there is some resemblance to this process today and other
tre of the mouth, that is to move towards [a] especially in unstressed posi­
phonemes may move up to fill the places left vacant.
tion.
168 Chapter VI. Social and Territorial Varieties of English 6.3. English-based Pronunciation Standards of English 169

Centering of short vowels: 4. Changes in length


It is an accepted fact that English vowels vary in length according to
[a] [<e]
the phonetic context - the consonant they are followed by (voiceless,
[u] ~[a]/ [e] voiced), syllabic border, the degree of stress, the types of nuclear tone and
so on.
[A] / ~ [I]
Actually nowadays there are changes in vowel length that are influ­
enced by other factors. There is, for example, a strong tendency for the
Vertical changes may be traced in the following: so-called short vowels to be lengthened, and it is interesting to note that
final [£] and [I] may be very open this lengthening can be heard sporadically in many words in any posi­
better ['beta] > ['bet3] tion.
city ['sItr] > ['sIta] The lengtheningof[r] is often heard in big, his, is; of[u] ingood; [A] in
b) [e] [;):] tend to be closer in "advanced" RP come. It should also be mentioned that [I] is often lengthened in the final
dead [ded] > [ded] as in Russian ".z:\em" syllable, i. e. very, many: ['veri:], ['meni:].
bought [b;):t] > [bu:t] Short vowels fe, <e] are also very frequently lengthened in yes, bed,
c) the nuclei ofdiphthongs [el, Ea, ;)a, ua] become more open when these men, said, sad, bad, bag and so on. This tendency has considerably in­
phonemes are being levelled, particularly the diphthong [£a] which is char­ creased in the past few years.
acterized by a more opening of the nucleus:
careful ['kEaful] > ['kdul] Changes in Consonant Quality
The first element of the diphthong [ua] can be lowered considerably 1. Voicing and devoicing. As is well known, there is no opposition offinal
poor [pua] > [po"]. RP cons.Onants according to the work of the vocal cords. They are all par­
tially devoiced, particularly stops. Such dev.Oiced sounds are clearly heard
3. Combinative changes after l.Ong vowels and diphthongs as in deed: [di:d]. However, these partly
It i,s general knowledge that when sounds are in company they influ­ dev.Oiced c.Onsonants are never identical with their voiceless c.Ounterparts,
ence each other. These changes are called combinative. They take place because the latter are pron.Ounced with strong breath-f.Orce.
only in certain phonetic contexts. In a diacritic study, however, there is no This tendency for devoicing now seems to be on the increase. A,> s.O.On as
sharp boundary between isolative and combinative changes. the opp.Osition ofvoi.ced voiceless is neutralized in the final position, the
I) Changes in [j + u:], [I + u:]. Words like suit, student, super may be pro­ fortis/lenis character of pronunciati.On has become the relevant feature of
nounced either [sju:t] or [su:t], ['stju:dant] or [,stu:dant], ['sju:pa] or ['su:pa]. consonants.
The tendency is for middle-aged and younger speakers to omit the [j] after The v.Oiced/voiceless distinction of the minimal pairs [sed] - [set],
[s] before [u:]. Word-internally [j] tends to be retained as in assume [asju:m]. [dug] [duk] may seem t.O be lost. Actually it does not take place. The weak
There is also fluctuation after [I]: word-initially lute [Iu:t] is normal, but it is consonants are never replaced by their voiceless counterparts, they never
possible to pronounce [J'lju:3n] in illusion, for example. These recent devel­ become strong, the stops Ib, d, gJ, though devoiced, never acquire aspira­
opments in combinative RP changes bear remarkable resemblance to Amer­ tion. More than that. The interrelati.On of final consonants and the preced­
ican Standard pronunciation. ing stressed vowels is very close.
2) Change of [;):] to [u] before [f, s, 9]. Where orthographic "0" occurs
before the voiceless fricative [f, s, 8] older speakers pronounce the vowel [;):]: He saw his cap. - He saw his cab.
loss [b:s]. This pronunciation is currently dying out in RP and being re­ Describing the positional alloph.Ones .Ofthe English stops A. C. Gimson
placed by [u]: [Ius]. characterizes the initial lenis [b, d, g] as partially devoiced, finallenis [b, d, g]
Words like salt and fault still may be pronounced with as voiceless.
170 Chapter VI. Social and Territorial Varieties of English 6.3. English-based Pronunciation Standards of English 171

The sound [t] in the intervocalic position is made voiced: orthographic "r". RP is a non-rhotic accent but most speakers ofit do pro­
better ['beta] nounce orthographic "r" word-finally before a vowel: It is a facaway count­
letter f'leta1 ['Ieda] ry. It is known as linking "r". Failure by students to pronounce it does not
usually affect comprehension but may result in their sounding foreign.
2. Loss of [h]. In rapid speech initial As a further development and by analogy with linking "r", "r" is in­
to die out from the language. Even most highly educated people subcon­ serted before a following vowel even though there is no "r" in spelling.
sciously drop it completely. So instead of: She wants her to come [Ii" ""wnnts This "r" is known as intrusive "r". The actual situation is that younger RP
ta JAm] one hears: ti: wnnts 3 ta ,kAm]. It is evident, of course, that the speakers do have it after [s] as in idea of, China and.
loss of fh 1in stressed syllables sounds wrong. It is said that nowadays in colloquial fluent speech there is a strong
tendency towards elision, reduction and assimilation. This tendency is
3. Initial "hw". Some conservative RP speakers pronounce words like reflected in the pronunciation ofthe young generation: tutor ('t[u:ta],
why, when, which with an initial weak breath-like sound [h] [M]. The gen­ second year ['sekand3Ia], perhaps you [pa'hi€p[u:], gives you ['9rv3u:1, as
eral tendency is, however, to pronounce [w]. you know [a3ju: 'n3u]; in the transcribed texts of British textbooks: him
[1m], he (i:], her [3'], his [IZ], can [kn],from (frm], than [on], them [am],
4. Loss of final [!J]. The pronunciation of [m] for the termination h!J] some [sm], suppose [Sp3UZ], have to ['hafta], usually ['jU:3walIJ, last time
has been restrained as an archaic form of the RP: sittin', lookin'. , and there was no one [an oar wz 'nsu WAn]; even in the tra­
These occasional usages are not likely to become general. ditional spelling: C'm on, baby, Sorry 'bout that. Oh, le'mme see. Oh,
I dunno. Must've put'em all together. Why d'you ask? What dja think?
5. Spread of "dark" [.l]. This tendency is evidently influenced by the Alright!
American pronunciation and some advanced RP speakers are often heard
saying [i] instead of [I] as in believe, for example. There is no threat in
9. Combinative changes. Sound combinations [tj, dj, sj] are pronounced
spreading it widely yet but it is quite common for pop singers now. It should
as [tf, d3,J] respectively, e. g. actual ['i€ktjual] - ['i€kt[ual], graduate
also be mentioned that sometimes final [.l J tends to be vocalized as in people. ['gri€djuaJt] ['gri€d3uelt], issue ['Isju:] ['rSu:].
But it is not likely to become a norm.
In the clusters oftwo stops, where the loss ofplosion is usually observed,
each sound is pronounced with audible release, e. g. active ['i€~tIv] - ['i€k­
6. Glottal stop. In RP the glottal stop ['l] can appear only in the f'ol­
bV], sit down ['sltdaun] - [,Sit 'daun].
lowing two environments: a) as a realization of syllable-final [t] before a
[j] is lost following [1, s, z]: suit [su:t] and after I n I: news
following consonant as in batman ['bi€tman] - ['bi€'lmn] or not quite
- ['nn'] 'kwalt]; b) in certain consonant clusters as in box, simply
[bn'lks], ['sr'lmplJ], where it is known as "glottal reinforcements". The use Non-systematic wiations in RP Phonemes
of glottal stop by advanced RP speakers produces a "clipped" effect on a Some free phonemes have appeared under the influence of the written
foreigner. image ofwords, their spelling.
Unstressed prefixes ex- and con- have gained orthographical pronun­
7. Palatalized final [k'] is often heard in words week, quick, etc.: ciation: excuse [Iks'kju: z] - [eks'kju:z], exam [Ig'zi€m] - [eg'zi€m], continue
[kwlk']. [kan'tmju:] - [knn'tmju:J, consent [kan'sent] [knn'sent].
The days of the week: Sunday ['SAndI] - ['SAndel], Monday ['mAndl] ­
8. Linking and intrusive [r]. It has been estimated that all English ac­ ['mAndel],
cents are divided into "rhotic" or "r-full" and "non-rhotic" or "r-less". Note also free variants in often: ['nfan] ­
Rhotic accents are those which actually pronounce [r] corresponding to Other cases: economics [,Ika'nnmlks] - [,eka'nnmlks].
172 Chapter VI. Social and Territorial Varieties of English 6.3. English-busI'd 111111111110 11111111 rll,1I1uurds of English 173
------------------------------
Some Changes in Intonation We can al~() 111111' III", IIhlllV northern speakers while they do not have
[A] have [u:J mlllt'l 111,111 H ill words such as hook, book, look. They there­
a) Spread of rising tones in final intonation groups, especially in de­ fore distinguish plIII-, III., ";I,d, nnd buck, which in the South sound [buk]
scriptive monologues: and [bAk], in till' NIlIIII d', 11'11 II. I and [buk]:
I'd "'like to about my,self I was '"*bom in ,London. My .•,,"111 North
'"*parents were divorced...
p.nll [bu:k]
b) frequent use of Low Falling tone in tags (disjunctive questions):
I""d [buk]
'"*LoveIyd . "
\ ay, \lsn t It.
?
distinguishes northern and southern
c) Common use of rising tones in special questions, expressing interest
and personal involvement on the part of the speaker.
1,·'1
e,
Before the vok'l·!t-·.·.II II ,IIIWI{ II, s1 and certain consonant clusters con­
'"* Where were you ,born? taining initial [n 1111 I111I I' I i'l pl'Onounced in the North instead of

Now byway ofconclusion we would like to state that some ofthe changes ....111 II
~-----------~----------------~
are quite stable, others tend to disappear. It is only natural since the language path It 111111
is a living body and its development is particularly marked in pronunciation. ~----------~~~------------~
dance Idll
It is important to be aware of the recent developments in pronunciation,
which in the opinion of many prominent phoneticians may lead to radical Note: Speakers will! 111111(\ strongly regional southern substandard ac­
changes in the whole inventory ofvowel and consonant phonemes. cents may not have ilH' I 11111 htNt or, at most, have a contrast that is variable.
In the South, hown! I, 11'1 is often pronounced as [a:J:
6.3.4. Regional non-RP accents of Engiand
III' I South

As was stated above, we grouped regional accents of England into south­


Ih,·d I I [ba:d]

ern and northern ones. This division is very approximate ofcourse, because
there are western and eastern accents but their main accent variations cor­ One more major 11111111 Mouth differentiating feature involves the final
respond either with southern or northern accentual characteristics. Thus we
[i:] like in words city, /llIIIIr'I" etc. In the north of England they have
would like to point out here the main differences between southern and the south of England 1111 ',,' words are pronounced with
northern accents.
Vowels ~ 11111 h North
One of the main differences between these groups of accents is in the city 1',,11 ['SIb]
phoneme inventory - the presence or absence of particular phonemes.
money I'IIIA ni:] ['mum]
Typically, the vowel fAl does not occur in the accents of the north:

South North
Consonants
blood
It has been mentiolll'll ilhove that some English accents are, "rhotic" or
one "r-full" and others are "ll!1ll"rhotic" or "r-less". Rhotic accents are those
but which actually pronoulh',' 11'1, corresponding to orthographic "r" in words
174 Chapter VI. Social and Territorial Varieties of English 6.3. English-based Pronunciation Standards of English 175

like bar andfarm. This [f] sound is post-vocalic and is most often heard in 6. RP [30] sounds as [eeo]: soaked [s30kt] - [s<£okt];
Scotland, Ireland and in the southwest of England.
In most regional accents the glottal stop is more widely used than in RP. 7. RP may be [<£d]: now [nao] ­
In some areas, especially the north-east of England, East AngJia and North­
ern Ireland, the glottal stop may also be pronounced simultaneously with Consonants
the voiceless [p, t, k], most strikingly between vowels: pity ['pJt?i:]. 1. [h] in unstressed position is almost invariably absent;
Many non-RP speakers use In] in the suffIX "-tng" instead of [u]; sitting
['sltm]. In the western area of central England which includes Birmingham, 2. [1] is widely spread in Cockney speech: paper ['p<£11pd], butterfly
Manchester and Liverpool they pronounce lUg]: singer ['SIUgd], wing ['bA1tdflal] ;
[wIUg]· 3. the contrast between [0] and [f] is completely lost: thin [frn], booth
Now about [j]-dropping. In most accents [j] is dropped after It, s]: stu­
dent ['stu:ddnt], suit [so:t]. In parts of the north the change has progressed a 4. the contrast between [0] and [v] is occasionally lost: weather ['wevd]
good deal further, it is lost after [0]: enthusiasm [en'0u:zldzm]. 5. when [0] occurs initially it is either dropped or replaced by [d]: this [diS],
In large areas of eastern England [j] is lost after every consonant. In them [(d)dm];
London [j] is lost after [n, t, d]: news [nu:z], tune [tu:n].
6. [I] is realized as a vowel when it precedes a consonant and follows a
vowel, or when it is syllabic: milk [mlvk], table [teIbv]; when the preced­
A. Southern English Accents ing vowel is [J:], [I] may disappear completely;
We now turn to an examination of regional non-RP accents of England 7. [U] is replaced by [n] in word-final position: dancing ('du:nsm] or it may
and we shall first give a brief outline of the group of Southern accents. be pronounced as [IUk] in something, anything, nothing: ['nAfIuk];
As it was stated above, educated Southern speech is very much near-RP
accent whereas non-standard accents are similar to Cockney. So we are go­ 8. [p, t, k] are heavily aspirated, more so than in RP;
ing to give a detailed description of this London accent. 9. rtl is affricated, [s] is heard before the vowel: top [tsnp].
It has been long established that Cockney is a social accent typical of
the speech of working class areas of Greater London. Here are some pro­
B. Northern and Midland Accents
nunciation features of Cockney.
Midland accents, Yorkshire, for example, \\est Midland and North­
Vowels­ West accents have very much in common with Northern ones. Therefore
they are combined in this book into one group; peculiar realization of vow­
1. [A] is realized as [<£1]: blood [blAd] - [bl<£id];
els and consonants will be marked, of course, when each subgroup is de­
2. [ee] is realized as [E] or lEI]: bag [b<£g] - [bEg], [bElg]; scribed separately.
The countries ofnorthern England are not far from the Scottish border,
3. [I] in word-final position sounds as Ii:]: city ('Sib] (,Slti:]; so the influence of Scotch accent is noticeable, though there are of course
4. when [J:] is non-final, its realization is much closer, it sounds like [0:]; many features of pronunciation characteristic only of northern English re­
pause [pJ:z] - [po:z]; when it is final, it is pronounced as [J:d]: paw gions. The most typical representative of the speech of this area is Newcas­
- [PJ:d]; tle accent. It differs from RP in the following:

5. the diphthong is realized as [eel] or [al]: lady ['Ieldl]


Vowels
['Ialdi:] ;

I. RP rA1 is realized as love [IAV] ­


]76 Chapter VI. Social and Territorial Varieties of English 6.3. English-based Pronunciation Standards of 177

2. RP final [I] sounds like [i:]: city ['sIb] [,slti:]; 6.3.5. Welsh English
3. words like dance, chance which in RP have [a:] are pronounced with Wales is a bilingual area. This speech situation in linguistics is known
lee]: [deens], [tJeens];
as exoglossic. In Wales English dominates ovel' Welsh in urban areas, in
4. [eI] , [3U] are either monophthongs, or much narrower diphthongs that the the west and north-west of the country the balance being in favour of
ones in the south of England, or they may even sound as opening diph­ Welsh, where English is learnt at schools as a secolid language. At the mo­
thongs [Ie], [uoJ: bay [be:], [bleJ, plate [ple:t), [plJet], boat [bo:t], ment nationalistic feelings are rather strong in Wales and we are witness­
ing a movement in favour of the revival of the Welsh language and its
5. words that have "al" in spelling - talk, call, all, are pronounced with
spread in all areas of Wales.
[a:]: [ta:k], [ka:l], [a:IJ;
However, Welsh English at the level of educated speech and writing is
6. RP words with [3:] are pronounced with [J:] in a broad Tyneside accent: not much different from that of English English. Most differences are
first [hst], shirt [fJ:tJ; sofirst,jorced; shirt, short are homonyms; found at the level of more localized dialects.
this chapter we shall give a brief outline of Welsh English pronun­
7. raIl is [81]: right
ciation standard.
8. words which in RP have may have e. g. about [';;1bu:t].
The principal phonological differences between WE and RP are the
Consonants
following:
1. [IJ is clear in all environments;
Vowels
2. [hJ is usually present in all positions;
1. The distribution of [ee] and [a:] is as in the north of England. Last,
3. -ing is [m]: shilling
dance, chance, etc. tend to have [ee] rather than [a:J;
4. [p, t, k] between vowels are accompanied by glottal stop pity 2. unstressed orthographic "a" tends to be [ee] rather than [;;1], e. g. : sofa
[,Plt?i:] ;
['so:f ee] ;
5. in parts of Northumberland and Durham [r] may be uvular (in its pro­
3. there is no contrast between [A] and [;;1]: rubber ['r;;1b;;1];
duction the tongue and the uvula, not the tongue and the alveolar ridge
take part). 4. [I] at the end is a long vowel: city [,slti:];
5. in words like tune, few, used we find [iu] rather than [ju:]: tune
Yorkshire accents [tiun];

Yorkshire and Bradford accents are identical with northern vowel fea­ 6. reJl, [3U] may becomc monophthongs: bake [bc:.:k], boat [bo:tJ;
tures in points 1, 3, 4 (only many speakers pronounce words which have
7. the vowel [a:llIs in girl is produced with rounded lips approaching [0:];
"ow", "ou" in spelling with [3UJ: know [3U]; with northern consonant fea­
tures in point 3. 8, the vowels [101, Ith)1 do not occur in many variants of Welsh English:
Now having accomplished the description of regional non- RP accents fear is ['fi:jal, poor Is I'PU:W;;1].
of England we would like to say that we didn't attempt to give a detailed ac­
count of all the regional differences in accents of remote rural areas. We Consonants
concentrated on urban accents which are more likely to be encountered by 1. Welsh English is nOIH'hotic, [r] is a tap, or it is also called a flapped
foreign tourists.
. Intrusive und linking [r] do occur.
178 Chapter VI. Social and Territorial Varieties of English 6.3. English-based Pronunciation Standards of English 179

2. Consonants in intervocalic position, particularly when the preceding RP Scottish English

vowel is short are doubled: city ['sltti:]. beer

bird [b3:d]

3. Voiceless plosives tend to be strongly aspirated: in word final position


hurt [h3:t] [hArt]

they are generally released and without glottalization, e. g. pit


bard [ba:d] [ba:rd]

[phlth] .
moor [moa] [mm]

4. fll is clear in all positions.


2. Length is not a distinctive feature of Scottish vowels. So pairs like
pool - pull, cot - caught are not distinguished. It should be noted,
Intonation in Welsh English is very much influenced by the Welsh lan­
however, that vowels are longer in final stressed open syllables than
guage.
elsewhere.
3. Monophthongs are pure, there is no trace of diphthongization with the
6.3.6. Scottish English
exceptions of [a I] [81], lao] - [80] and
we must first make clear that the status ofScottish English is still debated. 4. The RP [~] - [a:(a)] distinction doesn't exist: hat [hat], dance
Some linguists say that it is a national variant. Others say that it is a dialect.
English has been spoken in Scotland for as long as it has been spoken in 5. [I], [0] may be centraL
England. In the Highlands and Islands of northern and western Scotland, 6. In non-standard Scottsih English accent [u:] often occurs when RP has
however, Gaelic is still the native language of thousands of speakers from
lao]: house [haos] [hu:s].
these regions. A standardized form of this language, known as Scots, was
used at the court and in literature until the Reformation. Then it was gradu­ 7. It is interesting to mention that [u] and may be not contrasted.

ally replaced by English. Incidentally a number of writers and poets of the not ________

socks
likes of R. Burns retained their native language. ______ [not]
[soksl

Nowadays educated Scottish people speak a form of Scottish Standard note

soaks
English which grammatically and lexically is not different from English
used elsewhere, although with an obvious Scottish accent. We must admit, 8. In very many regional accents do, to are pronounced as [da1, [ta J.
however, that non-standard dialects of Scotland still resemble Scots and in 9. In some accents words such as ann, after, grass may have [8] rather

many respects are radically different from most other varieties of English. It [a:]: after

is very difficult to understand them for students who learn RP.


At the moment there is currently a strong movement in Scotland for the Consonants
revival of Scots. Nevertheless Scottish Standard English is still more presti­
geous and in this book we concentrate on Scottish English as used and spo­ 1. Scottish English consistently preserves a distinction between fMl and
ken by educated urban Scots. [w 1: which [Mltf] witch
As for the status of Scottish English, in this book it will be treated as a 2. Initial [p, t, k] are usually non-aspirated.
dialect though it is fair to say that there is much in favour of calling it a na­
tional variant of English. 3. [r] is most usually a flap.
4. Non-initial [t] is often realized as glottal stop [1].
Vowels­
5. f11 is dark in all positions.
1. Since Scottish English is rhotic, i. e. it preserves post-vocalic [r], vowels
such as RP [Ia], [3:], [lOa], loa] do not occur: 6. The velar fricative [xl occurs a number of words: loch [lux].
180 Chapter VI. Social and Territorial Varieties of English 6.3. English-based Pronunciation Standards of English 181

7. -ingis [Ill]. Republic, Donegal, for instance, speak Northern Ireland English, while
some ofthe no.rthern provinces speak Southern Ireland English.
8. [h] is present.
In this chapter we shall deal with Northern Ireland English pronuncia­
9. A specific Scottish feature is the pronunciation of [er] as [Ir]: through tion.
[Jru:].
Vowels'
Non-systematic Difference The vowel system is to that of Scottish accents, post-vocalic ret­
Some words have pronunciation distinctively different from RP: roflex frictionless sonol'ant 11'1 used as in Scotland.

RP Scottish English pit


bee _.
length [leU e] [e]: pet [pet], bed I
raspberry ['ru:zbn] [!O]: bay [be], bear 1
realize but [bAt];
though [03U] [a]: pat [pat], bard 11)I]l'dl, halllwll, dance [dans], haif[haf];
tortoise ['b:tas] [u]: put [put], boolll.mli. pull Ipoll, pool I pull, poor [pur];
[0]: boat [bot], boartl IIlC11'(j I, pole' Ipoll, knows [noz], nose [noz],pour [par],
pore [par];
[;):]: paw [P;):], dol/ld,l;ll, /HIIIS(' 11>'1:~,1;
6.3.7. Northern Ireland English [n]: cot [kut];
It should be stated first of all that English pronunciation standards in [aI]: buy [bal], tic/ellnulj:
Northern Ireland and in the Republic of Eire are different. The explanation [au]: bout [buut];
lies in history. , [;)1]: boy [b;)I].
Tn the Middle Ages almost the whole of Ireland was Irish speaking. The following nol~':1 UII rcad in ";>;>VvlaLIVll the
Nowadays, however, native speakers ofIrish are few in number and are con­ above.
fined to rural areas even though Irish is the official language of Ireland and The may vary considerably according to the
is taught in schools. The English language in Southern Ireland was origi­
nally introduced from the West and West Midlands of England
shows signs of this today. This kind of English has spread to cover most of L in words , vuwcl is a monophthong [e], preconsonan­
the Irish Republic. Naturally the pronunciation of these areas retains fea­ tally it may be u dip"l onhc type lea] - [Id]: gate [glat];
tures ofwestern parts of England. 2. [;):], [u] are flljl'l,VV~'lIlInl:
The English of northern parts ofthe island with its centre in Belfast has
its roots in Scotland, as large numbers of settlers carne to this part from the
3. [;):] and 1.'01 c()lllrw.i ollly bolbl'c [p, t, k];
south-west of Scotland from the seventeenth century onwards. Now speak­ 4. [all, [au] arc W1Y villi"hl~~;
ing about Northern Ireland, it is true to say that English here is not homo­
5. realization oflll:IIlIiIY VBI)' considerably.
geneous. Areas ofthe far north are heavily Scots-influenced. Other parts are
marked by less heavily Scots-influenced varieties of English. It is, ofcourse, Consonants
obvious that the language distinction is not coterminous with the political
division ofthe Republic ofIreland and Northern Ireland, some areas ofthe 1. [I] is mainly l'l"[lI';
182 Chapter VI. Social and Territorial Varieties ofEnglish 6.4. American-based Pronunciation Standards of English 183

2. intervocalic [t] is often a voiced flap city ['slrli:]; zation ofsome pure vowels and monophthongization ofsome diphthongs at the
expense ofprolonging ("drawling") their nuclei and dropping the glides.
3. between vowels [0] may be lost: mother ['m;):ar]
3. The third type of educated American speech is General American
4. [h] is present.
(GA), also known as Northern American or Western American spoken in
central Atlantic States: New York, New Jersey, Wisconsin and others. GA
pronunciation is known to be the pronunciation standard ofthe USA. There
6.4. American-based Pronunciation Standards of English are some reasons for it. GA is the form ofspeech used by the radio and televi­
sion. It is mostly used in scientific, cultural and business intercourse. Also in
The American variant of English has been very thoroughly described by
two important business centres - New York and St. Louis - GA is the pre­
many prominent scholars both in this country and in the USA. In this book,
vailing form ofspeech and pronunciation, though New York is situated with­
however, we shall try to follow the conception introduced by A. D. Shweitzer
in the territory where Eastern American is spoken, and S1. Louis is within the
in his sociolinguistic approach to the treatment of contemporary speech
region of Southern American. In this chapter we shall give an outline of GA
situation in America.
accent. We will then point to differences between this accent and RP.
The sociolinguistic situation in the United States is very complicated. It
is moulded by certain linguistic, cultural, historic, demographic, geograph­
ic, political and other factors. 6.4.1. General American
Generally speaking, the situation in the USA may be characterized as
Vowels
exoglossic, i. e. having several languages on the same territory, the balance
being in favour ofAmerican English. 1. There is no strict division ofvowels into long and short in GA, though
It is true, of course, that the formation of the American Standard un­ some American phoneticians suggest that certain GA vowels are tense and
derwent the influence of minorities' languages, but its starting point was likely to be accompanied by relative length: [i:] in seat, [u:] in pool.
English language of the early 17th century. However, time has passed, They also admit that a slight rise in tongue position during the pronun­
American English has drifted considerably from English English though as ciation of tense vowels leads to a diphthongal quality of tense vowels which
yet not enough to give us ground to speak of two different languages. contrasts to a monophthongal quality oflax vowels.
we speak of the national variant of English in America.
2. Classification of vowels according to the stability of articulation is a
American English shows a lesser degree ofdialect than British English due
very controversial subject in GA. Some diphthongs are treated as biphone­
to some historical factors: the existence ofStandard English when first English
rnic combinations. The inventory of GA diphthongs varies from three to
settlers came to America, the high mobility ofpopulation, internal migrations
twelve phonemes. Following D. Shakhbagova we distinguish here five diph­
ofdifferent communities and so on. As regards pronunciation, however, it is not
thongs in GA: [el], [al], [;)1], [au], [au].
at all homogeneous. There are certain varieties of educated American speech.
In the USA three main types of cultivated speech are recognized: the Eastern 3. Another important feature that causes different interpretations of
type, the Southern type and Western or General American. diphthongs and vowel length in GA is the pronunciation of [r] between a
vowel and a consonant or between a vowel and a silence: tum [t3f n], bird
1. The Eastern type is spoken in New England, and in New York city. It
star [sta:'].
bears a remarkable resemblance to Southern English, though there are, of
It has been estimated that 2/3 of American population pronounce
course, some slight differences.
and 1/3 omit it. Thus GA is rhotic. In words likefar, core, when [r] follows
2. The Southern type is used in the South and South-East of the USA. It the vowels and ends the word this sound is consonantal and non-syllabic. It
possesses a striking distinctive feature - vowel drawl, which is a specific way of involves the characteristic hindering of the free flow ofbreath which we as">
pronouncing vowels, consisting in the diphthongization and even triphthongi­ sociate with consonants. The sound [r] in far closes the syllable more dcH"
184 Chapter VI. Social and Territorial Varieties of English 6.4. American-based Pronunciation Standards 185

nitely than in British Received Pronunciation of the word [fa:]. On the oth­ Consonants
er hand, there is a vocalic or vowel-like and syllabic [r] that occurs in words
1. The RP allophonic differentiation of [I] does not exist in GA. In all
like bird, murmur, after a vowel and before a consonant.
positions [I] is fairly dark.
4. One more peculiar feature of pronunciation of vowels in American
2. Intervocalic [t] as in pity is most normally voiced. The result is neu­
English is their nasalization, when they are preceded or followed by a nasal
tralization of the distribution between [t] and [d] in this position, i. e. latter,
consonant (in such words as take, small, name, etc. ). Nasalization is often
ladder. The original distinction is preserved through vowel length with the
called an American twang. It is incidental and need not be marked in pho­
vowel before [t] being shorter.
nemic transcription.
In words like twenty, little [t] may even drop out. Thus winner and win­
S. GA front vowels are somewhat different from RP. ter, for example, may sound identical.
In words like very,pity GAhas [i:] rather than [I]. In word flnalposition
3. GA [r] is articulated differently from RP one. The impression is one
it is often even diphthongized.
of greater retroflexion (the tip of the tongue is curled back further than in
The vowel [e] is more open in GA. It also may be diphthongized before
RP).
[p], [t], [k]: let [Ieot].
spelling is represented in GA by [M] sound (or sometimes
6. There are four mixed or central vowels in GA: [3], [aJ, [A], [a]. They
as LhW]. So most American speakers make a clear distinction
differ markedly from RP vowels in articulation and distribution.
and "w" words: where - ware, which - witch.
7. The three RP vowels [u], [ee], [a:] correspond to only two vowels in
weakened or omitted altogether in GA
GA- [a] and [eel. This combined with the articulatory differences between
tween a consonant (especialJ one) and [ttl as in the words:
RP [u] and GA [a] and a difference in vowel distribution in many sets of
news [nu:z], Tuesday suit rsu:t 1. tube ftu:b 1. stupid
words makes it very complicated. The following chart vividly shows it:
['stu:pId], during
RP GA
dad [ee] [ee]

dog
Non-systematic Differences between General American and Received Pro­
path
nunciation
dance

1. Many differences involve the pronunciation of individual words or


half

groups of words. Here are some of these:


Besides word distribution of [::>:] , [u] in RP and GAis completely differ­ RP GA
ent. GA [::>] is intermediate in quality between the RP [::>:] and [u]. In its
Asia ['erIal ['eI 3 a]

production the lips are considerably less rounded.


cordial ['kJ:dral] [brjal]

8. Now to the qualities of GA diphthongs. either ['a loa] [,i:oar]

a) the diphthong fer] is closer in GA as opposed to RP;


leisure ['le 3a] ['li:3 ar1

b) the nucleus of [3U] tends to be more advanced in GA;


lever ['li:va] [,Ievar]

c) since GA is a rhotic accent with non-prevocalic [r], it has the conse­


schedule [,Jedju:l] [,skedjal]

quence that the following RP vowels (derived historically from vowel shone [fun] [faun]

+[r]) do not occur in GA: [ra] in dear - GA [drr], lea] in dare - GA tomato [ta'ma:tau] [ta'meltau]

[derr], [ua] in tour - GA [tur]. vase [va:z] [veIz]

186 Chapter VI. Social and Territorial Varieties of English 6.4. American-based Pronunciation Standards of English 187

2. Words apparatus, data, status can be pronounced with either [::e] or I don't want to go to the theatre.
in GA, but only with [el] in RP.
3. Words like hostile, missile, reptile have final [ail] in RP.
may have [el].
Stress Differences
GA they
RP
-"\,
GA

Its emphatic variant in Mid-wavy-Ievel Head:

-
'-""
1. In words of French origin GA tends to have stress on the fmal sylla­ GA .~~.~ ..
ble, while RP has it on the initial one:
2. The usual Medium or Low Fall in RP has its rising-falling counter­
RP GA
partin GA:
ballet [,b::elel] [b::e'lel]

beret
Come and see me tomorrow.
2. Some words have first-syllable stress in GA whereas in RP the stress RP GA -' ",
may be elsewhere. \.
RP GA

address [e'dres] ['::edres]


3. The rising terminal tone in RP in GA has a mid-rising contour:
cigarette [sIge'ret] [,slgeret]

Do you like it?


magazine [m::ege'zi:n] ['m::egazm]

research [n's3:tf] ['nsatf]

RP GA
adult [e'dAlt] ['::edAIt]

inquiry [IlJ'kwalan] ['llJkwalen]

Or it may have a level tone in GA:


3. Some compound words have stress on the first element in GA and in
RP they retain it on the second element: weekend, ice-cream, hot dog, New
Year.
4. The Fall-Rise nuclear tone is different in RP and GA:
4. Polysyllabic words ending in -ory, -ary, -many have secondary stress
in GA, often called "tertiary": laboratory ['I::ebr<l,bn], dictionary ['dlkJ<l,nen], Really?
secretary ['sekr<l,ten], testimony [,testi,moum].
RP
~
GA ,../
Intonation Differences
These comparisons show that the main differences in intonation con­
GA intonation on the whole is similar to that of RP. But there are, of cern the direction of the voice pitch and the realization of the terminal
course, some differences that shOUld be mentioned here. tones. In GA the voice doesn't fall to the bottom mostly. This explains the
I. In sentences where the most common pre-nuclear contour in RP is a fact that the English speech for Americans sounds "affected" and "preten­
gradually descending sequence, the counterpart GA contour is a medium tious" or "sophisticated". And for the English, Americans sound "dull",
Level Head: "monotonous", "indifferent".
~~~--------======:-:--~---~-.~~-.- ~ .

188 Chapter Vl. Social and Territorial varieties of English Summary 189

It should also be mentioned that the distribution of terminal tones in To describe territorial varieties we refer to the national variants and na­
sentences types is also different in both variants of English. tional pronunciation standards (RP in Great Britain, GA in the USA). Na­
tional pronunciation standards are not fIxed, they undergo changes under
1. GA "Yes, No" questions commonly have a falling terminal tone, the
the influence of various internal and external factors.
counterpart RP tone would be a rising one:
National variants faU into territorial or regional dialects. Dialects are
Shall we stay here? distinguished from each other by differences in pronunciation, grammar
and vocabulary. When we refer to varieties in pronunciation, we use the
RP ../ GA -. ---­ word "accent".
RP as the pronunciation standard ofGreat Britain is not homogeneous.
2. Requests in RP are usually pronounced with a Rise, whereas in GA Three types ofRP are distinguished: conservative (the language ofthe royal
they may take a Fall-Rise: family and aristocracy), general (spoken by educated people) and advanced
Open the door. (used by the younger generation). Advanced RP is believed to reflect the
new tendencies in pronunciation. There is another classification: general
RP RP, refIned RP (upper-class accent) and regional RP (representing regional
J GA \ .. .-/ standards). One of regional types of RP is Estuary English which is very
popular with the younger speakers.
3. Leave-takings are often pronounced with a high-pitched Fall-Rise in Regional accents of Great Britain can be grouped into Southern Eng­
GA: lish accents, Northern and Midland accents, Welsh English, Scottish Eng­
Goodnight. lish, Northern Ireland English.
\.-/ General American is viewed as the pronunciation standard ofthe USA.
The comparison ofRP and GA shows considerable differences in vowel and
In conclusion we would like to say that American phoneticians use a consonant systems, placement of stress and intonation.
pitch contour system to mark intonation in the text:

It's a very cold day.


~
Will you come? I
Will you come?

It is certain that we have not covered here all the cases of different into­
nation structures used in RP and GA. Recently there have appeared in this
country several papers and books on the subject, so for further information
see those books.

Summary
Variations in pronunciation can be accounted for with reference both to
geographical and social factors. In contemporary dialectology phonetic di­
versity is explained on the basis of the analysis of regional variants alongside
with such indicators as age, gender, education, occupation.
REFERENCES References 191

$oMu'teHlColl. r. KOrHHTl1BHIiIeOCHoBhIrrpOCOL\l1l!eCKOt! I1HTCPQ)epeHUHlf. BOJIrorpa,1(,


2005.
AHmunoea A. M. CI1CTeMa aHrJT11itcKOM peqeBoIi: MHTOHal(HI1. M.: BhlClIIaH lIIKOJIa, T.JepeMucuHa H. B. PyCCKaH HHTOHaUlfH. l103311H, npo:.m, pa3roBopHaH pe%. M., 1982.
1985. IlI8eu~ep A. $. COl(lfaJIbHaH ,1(lf<p<pepeHUlfaUI1I1 II aHI'JII1~CKOM H3hIKe s CllIA.

AHmunoea A. M. PI1TMJ7IQeCKaH CHCTeMa aHrJIJ7IitcKOH peQI1. M.: BblCillaH lIIKOJIa, 1983.


1984. me8'1.eHlCO T. H. COl(HaJIbHaH ,1(H<p<pepeHUHal\11l1 tHlI'J1I1~CKOro rrpOlf3HOlIIeHHH. M.:
ApalCuH B. J(. CpaBHMTeJIhHaH Tl1IIOJIOrHH aHrJIHMCKOrO MPYCCKOro H3bIKOS. M.: BIiIClIIaH IIIKOJIa, 1990.
ITpocseIIIeHJ7Ie, 1979. me8'teHlCO T. H. TeopeTM.'IecKaH <poHeTI1K8. all I'JlI1 f,!cKoro 513bIKa. M.: BhIciliaH IIIKOJIa,
EOiJy3H iJe KypmeHe If. A. If36paHHble TPY)l.hl rro 06IIIeMY H3bIK03HaHHIO. M., 1963. 2006.
EOlliJaplw 11. B. u iJp. OCHOBhl o6IIIeIi: <poHeTl1KH. Crr6, 2000. IIJ,ep6a ll. B. Cl>oHeTHKa <ppaHuY3cKoro H3bIKI.l. M., 1963.
EypaJI. E. A., FaJl.o'tlCuHa H. E., IlIee'teHlCo T. H. Cl>oHeTl1Ka cospeMeHHoro aHrJIJ7IifcKOrO
H3bIKa. M.: ACADEMIA, 2006. Abercrombie D. Problems and principles. London, 1956.
BUUlHe8ClCaJI. F. H. AHrJlJ7lMCKaH HHTOHal(HH (B YCJIOBHHX PYCCKOH MHTep<pepeHU~T11). Abercrombie D. Elements of General Phonetics. Edinburgh, 1967.
IIBaHoBo: I1saHoBcKHit rocY,1(apCTBeHHhIH YHJ7IBepCHTeT, 2002. BarberCh. Linguistic Change .in Present I)ay English. London, 1964
Buume8clCaJI. r. H., lle8uHa T. B. AHrJIMitCKaH cyrrpacemeH1'HaH <poHeTl1Ka. IIBaHoBo: Bloomfield L. Language. NY, 1933
IIBaHOBCKFIH rocY,1(apCTBeHHhlIi: YHJ7IsepC~ITeT, 2007.
Bolinger D. Intonation. London, 1972.
FauiJy'tulC C. M. llPOCO,1(MQeCKaH CHCTeMa cOBpeMeHHoro HeMel(Koro H3hIKa. MI1HCK,
Bolinger D. Intonation and its Uses. London: Edward Arnold, 1989.
1972.
Brazil D. The Communicative Value or Intonation. Cambridge, 1997.
$y6oeclCuu /0. A. AHaJIJ7I3 HHTOHa:I!MH YCTHoro TeKCTa H ero COCTaBJIHIOIIII1X.. MHHCK,
1978. Brazil D., Coulthard M., Johns C. Discourl>c Intonation and Language Teaching. Lon­
don: Longman, 1980.
$y6oeclCuu /0. A. llPOco,1(HQeCKHe KompaCThI s H3hIKe. CHM<pepOrroJIh: CfY, 1983.
Brown G. Listening to Spoken English. M. : npoCBelUeHl1e, 1984.
3uHiJepll. P. 06IIIaH <poHenrKa. n. , 1982.
Carr Ph. English Phonetics and Phonology. Oxford: Oxford University Press, 1999.
3Jlamoycmo8a ll. B., flomanoea P. K. u iJp. 06IIIaH 11 rrpHKJIa,1(HaH <poHeTHKa. M.: MfY,
1997. Chomsky N. and Halle M. The Sound Pattern of English. N. Y , 1968.
KacamlCuH ll. ll. Cl>oHeTHKa COBpeMeHHoro PYCCKoro H3hIKa. M.: MIT, 2003. Couper-Kuhlen E. EngUsh Prosody. London: Edward Arnold, 1986.
KoiJ3aco8 C. B. , Kpu8Hoea O. $. 06IIIaH <poHeTI1Ka. M.: PfIT, 2001. Cruttenden A. Intonation. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press, 1986.
MUHaeea JL B. CJIOBO BH3hJKe HpeQH. M., 1986. Crystal D. Prosodic Systems and Intonations in English. Cambridge, 1969.
HUlCOllaeea T. M. CeMaHTHKa arrn;eH1'HOrO Bhl,1(eJIeHHH. M.: YPCC, 2004. Crystal D. The English Tone of\bice. L. , 1975.
HUlCollaeea T. M. Cl>pa30BaH lfHTOHal(HH CJIaBHHCKHXR3bIKOB. M., 1977. Crystal D. Linguistics. Penguin Books, 1977.
lIaHoe M. B. COBpeMeHHhlIi: PYCCKHit H3bIK. Cl>oHeTI1Ka. M., 1979. Crystal D. The Cambridge Encyclopedia ofthc English Language. Cambridge, 1995.
ClCpe6He8 /0. M. HopMa, HOpMaTl1BHhle peaJIlf3aI.(1111 H cy6bH3hIKOBaH crpYKTypa Crystal D. English as a Global Language. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press,
H3bIKa II HopMa peaJIlf3al(HH, Bapbl1pOBaHlfe H3bIKOBbIX cpe,1(CTB. fOPbKHH, 1997.
1980. Crystal D. How Language Works. London: Penguin Books, 2007.
COlColloea M. A. U iJp. llpaKTH'IeCKaH <poHeTI1Ka aHrJIHitcKOro H3hlKa. M.: BmvlOc, Fries Ch. Linguistics and Reading. New York, 1965.
2000. Gimson A. An Introduction to the Pronunciation of English. London: Edward Arnolds,
Topcyee F. fl. BOIIPOChi aKI.(eHTOJIOfl1lf cOBpeMeHHoro aHrJIHitcKoro H3bIKa. M., 1981.
1960. Gimson A. Gimson's Pronunciation of English. Sixth edition. Revised by A. Cruttenden.
Topcye8a H. r. I1HTOHal(J1}I HCMbICJI BhlCKa3bIBaHHH. M., 1979. London: Arnold, 2001.
Tpy6e~lCou H. C. OCHOBhl <pOHOJIOrMH. M., 1960. Halliday M. A. K. A Course of Spoken English: Intonation. The Hague: Mouton, 1970.
192 References

Hjelmsiev 1. Prolegomena to a Theory of Language. Madison, 1963.


Hughes A. , Trudgill P. English Accents and Dialects. London, 1980.
Jacobson R., Halle M. Fundamentals of Language. The Hague, 1956.
Jones D. The Phoneme: Its Nature and Use. Cambridge: Cambridge University
1967.
Jones D. An Outline of English Phonetics. Cambridge: Cambridge
1976
Kingdon R. The Groundwork of English Intonation. London: 1958.
Ladefoged P. A Course in Phonetics. N. Y. ,2001.
LaverJ. Press, 1995.
Units and Synt"f'tif'
1973.
Macaulay K. Social Class and Education. Edinburgh, 1977.
O'ConnorJ. D. Phonetics. London: Penguin, 1977.
O'Connor J. D. and Arnold G. F. Intonation of Colloquial English: A Practical Hand­
book. London: Longman, 1973.
Pennington M. Phonology in English Language Teaching: An International Approach.
London: Longman, 1996.
Pike K. The Intonation ofAmerican English. New York, 1958.
Pike K. Practical Phonetics of Rhythm Waves. Michigan, 1962.
Roach P. English Phonetics and Phonology: A Practical Course. Cambridge: Cambridge
University Press, 2001.
Shakhbagova D. Varieties of English Pronunciation. M., 1982.
Sommeifelt A. Can Syllabic Division Have Phonological Importance? / / Proceedings of
the II International Congress of Phonetic Sciences. Cambridge, 1936.
Trudgill P. Sociolinguistics: An Introduction. Harmondsworth, 1981.
Vasilyev V. A. English Phonetics: A Theoretical Course, M., 1970.
Wells J. C. Accents of English. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press, 1982.
Wells J. C. English Intonation. An introduction. Cambridge University Press, 2006.
Wells J. C. Longman Pronunciation Dictionary, 1993.
Wichmann A. Intonation in Text and Discourse. Harlow: Pearson Education Limited,
2000.

\:1

I,

i\

You might also like